More annual reports from Alterity Therapeutics Limited:
2025 ReportPeers and competitors of Alterity Therapeutics Limited:
Seer, Inc.Alterity Therapeutics Limited
ACN 080 699 065
Lodged with the ASX under Listing Rule 4.3A.
This information should be read in conjunction with the Annual report.
ANNUAL
REPORT
2024
An Alternate Future
Alterity Therapeutics Limited
ACN 080 699 065
Annual report – June 30, 2024
CONTENTS
CHAIRMAN’S LETTER
i
FORM 20-F
1
SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION
83
CORPORATE DIRECTORY
86
i
CHAIRMAN’S LETTER
Dear Shareholders,
I am excited to present the Alterity Therapeutics’ Annual Report as we made tremendous progress
over the last year.
MSA Program Hits Several Key Milestones
We currently have three programs ongoing targeting the rare, parkinsonian disorder known as Multiple
System Atrophy (MSA). MSA is an extremely debilitating disease with no approved treatments to
address the underlying condition. Our team is looking to change that paradigm in a truly meaningful
way.
First, we started our MSA program by running a natural history study with our esteemed colleagues at
Vanderbilt University in the U.S. This study is concluding and we are analyzing the trajectory of
disease severity in the enrolled patients to garner a deeper understanding of MSA on multiple levels
including key biomarkers, MRI data, and clinical outcomes. Impressively, as we announced in May
2024, the team has utilized machine learning (a form of artificial intelligence) to optimize specialized
MRI methods for measuring brain iron and brain volumes with precision. With the use of this
technology, the team has developed a novel imaging biomarker to assess brain volume in MSA
affected regions. The bioMUSE data showed a statistically significant increase in iron over 12 months
in the substantia nigra, and statistically significant decreases in brain volume observed in affected
regions at 12 months. These findings, alongside additional biomarker data presented during the year
have informed both of our Phase 2 clinical trials to ensure that we are enrolling the right patients who
may receive the most benefit from our lead asset, ATH434.
ATH434 is currently in two Phase 2 clinical trials in MSA in both early and more advanced patients.
This approach will provide data on patients with differing levels of severity as we look to advance the
asset into pivotal trials.
Our key Phase 2 study is a randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled trial that enrolled 77 adults
with early-stage MSA known as ATH434-201. In November 2023, we announced completion of
enrollment in this study and in May 2024 the Independent Data Monitoring Committee completed its
third prespecified review of unblinded clinical trial data. Consistent with the first two reviews, the DMC
expressed no concerns about safety and recommended that the study continue as planned without
modification. This recommendation is important for a chronic treatment as participants are able to
safely tolerate ATH434 as their time on study increases. The ATH434-201 trial remains on track and is
expected to be completed in November 2024 with topline data expected in January 2025.
Subsequent to the end of the fiscal year, we reported positive interim data from our open-label
biomarker trial in MSA patients with more advanced disease, known as ATH434-202. After six months
of treatment, 43% of participants showed improvement on the Unified MSA Rating Scale (UMSARS),
indicating reduced disability on activities of daily living. Over the same period, 29% of participants had
stable or improved neurological symptoms (clinical responders) as assessed by the global impression
of change by both the treating physician and the patient. Importantly, the clinical responders on
average had reduced accumulation of iron on MRI in key brain regions including the substantia nigra,
putamen and globus pallidus, as well as stable levels of Neurofilament Light Chain (NFL), a marker of
neuronal injury, when compared to participants who declined. While these preliminary findings are in a
small number of patients, we are extremely encouraged by these early results.
ii
Promising Non-Clinical Data in Parkinson’s Disease
We remain excited about the data we reported in December 2023 showing for the first time that
ATH434 can reduce Parkinson’s symptoms in a higher order animal, the monkey, with symptoms that
closely parallel human disease. The data showed that the improvements in motor skills and general
functioning were associated with reductions in iron in affected brain regions, validating the approach
we are using in our ongoing clinical trials. The data from this study improve our ability to predict
clinical outcomes and increases our confidence level in our ongoing Phase 2 clinical trials in Multiple
System Atrophy
Maintaining a Strong Presence at Medical and Scientific Meetings
During the year, we made multiple data presentations at prominent scientific meetings on ATH434, the
bioMUSE study, and our clinical trials. These included the annual meetings for the American Academy
of Neurology (AAN), the American Autonomic Society (AAS), the Society for Neuroscience, and the
International Congress of Parkinson’s Disease and Movement Disorders (MDS). These events continue
to generate excitement about ATH434 within the medical and scientific community about the approach
we are taking to treat Parkinson’s disease and related disorders.
Looking Ahead
We have an exciting year ahead particularly with the topline data expected from both of our Phase 2
clinical programs.
On behalf of the Board of Directors, I would like to extend our gratitude to the Alterity team and to the
individuals who have participated in our development programs. I would also thank our shareholders
for their continued support as we remain committed to creating an alternative future for people living
with neurodegenerative diseases.
Sincerely,
Geoffrey Kempler
Chairman and Founder
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington D.C. 20549
FORM 20-F
☐REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
OR
☒ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended June 30, 2024
OR
☐TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from __________ to __________
OR
☐SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
Date of event requiring this shell company report ___________
Commission file number 000-49843
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter and translation of Registrant’s name into English)
Australia
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
Level 14, 350 Collins Street, Melbourne, VIC 3000, Australia
(Address of principal executive offices)
David Stamler, Chief Executive Officer
Level 14, 350 Collins Street, Melbourne, VIC 3000, Australia
+61 3 9349 4906 (phone)
(Name, telephone, e-mail and/or facsimile number and address of company contact person)
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Trading Symbol
Name of each exchange on which registered
American Depositary Shares, each
representing 600 Ordinary Shares
ATHE
NASDAQ Capital Market
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act: None
Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual
report:
Ordinary Shares, as of June 30, 2024 5,245,115,318
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
Yes ☐ No ☒
If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
Yes ☐ No ☒
Note – Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 from their obligations under those Sections.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days.
Yes ☒ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of
Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such
files).
Yes ☒ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or an emerging growth company.
See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer ☐
Accelerated filer ☐
Emerging growth company ☐
Non-accelerated filer ☒
If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected
not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the
Exchange Act. ☐
† The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting
Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal
control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that
prepared or issued its audit report. ☐
If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the
filing reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐
Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive based compensation
received by any of the registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐
Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:
U.S. GAAP ☐
International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International
Accounting Standards Board ☒
Other ☐
If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to
follow:
Item 17 ☐ Item 18 ☐
If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).
Yes ☐ No ☒
This Annual Report on Form 20-F is incorporated by reference into our Registration Statements on Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-228671, 333-248980 and
333-251073) and our Registration Statements on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-274816, 333-250076 and 333-251647).
INTRODUCTION
Alterity Therapeutics Limited (formerly Prana Biotechnology Limited) was incorporated under the laws of the Commonwealth of Australia on
November 11, 1997. Our mission is to develop therapeutic drugs designed to treat neurogenerative diseases, currently focusing on Parkinsonian and other
movement disorders.
The principal listing of our ordinary shares and listed options to purchase our ordinary shares is on the Australian Securities Exchange, or ASX.
Since September 5, 2002, our American Depository Shares, or ADSs, have traded on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the symbol “PRAN.” On April
8, 2019, we changed our name to Alterity Therapeutics Limited and our ADSs have traded under the symbol “ATHE” since that date. The Bank of New
York, acting as depositary, issues American Depository Receipts, or ADRs, each of which evidences an ADS, which in turn represents 600 of our
ordinary shares. As used in this annual report, the terms “we,” “us,” “our”, “the Company”, “the Group” and “Alterity” mean Alterity Therapeutics
Limited and its subsidiaries, unless otherwise indicated.
Our consolidated financial statements appearing in this annual report are prepared in Australian dollars and in accordance with the International
Financial Reporting Standards, or IFRS, as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, or IASB and Australian equivalents to International
Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the Australian Accounting Standards Board.
Australian Disclosure Requirements
Our ordinary shares are primarily quoted on the Australian Securities Exchange (“ASX”) in addition to our listing of our ADSs on the Nasdaq
Capital Market. As part of our ASX listing, we are required to comply with various disclosure requirements as set out under the Australian Corporations
Act 2001 and the ASX Listing Rules. Information furnished under the sub-heading “Australian Disclosure Requirements” is intended to comply with the
ASX Listing Rules and Corporations Act 2001 disclosure requirements and is not intended to fulfill information required by this Annual Report on Form
20-F.
In this annual report, all references to “U.S. dollars” or “U.S.$” are to the currency of the United States, and all references to “Australian dollars”
or “A$” are to the currency of Australia.
Statements made in this annual report concerning the contents of any contract, agreement or other document are summaries of such contracts,
agreements or documents and are not complete descriptions of all of their terms. If we filed any of these documents as an exhibit to this annual report or
to any registration statement or annual report that we previously filed, you may read the document itself for a complete description of its terms.
Forward-Looking Statements
Except for the historical information contained in this annual report, the statements contained in this annual report are “forward-looking
statements” within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended, or the Exchange Act, and the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, as amended, with respect to our business, financial condition
and results of operations. Such forward-looking statements reflect our current view with respect to future events and financial results. We urge you to
consider that statements which use the terms “anticipate,” “believe,” “do not believe,” “expect,” “plan,” “intend,” “estimate,” and similar expressions are
intended to identify forward-looking statements. We remind readers that forward-looking statements are merely predictions and therefore inherently
subject to uncertainties and other factors and involve known and unknown risks that could cause the actual results, performance, levels of activity, or our
achievements, or industry results, to be materially different from any future results, performance, levels of activity, or our achievements expressed or
implied by such forward-looking statements. Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as
of the date hereof. Except as required by applicable law, including the securities laws of the United States, we undertake no obligation to publicly release
any update or revision to any forward-looking statements to reflect new information, future events or circumstances, or otherwise after the date hereof.
We have attempted to identify significant uncertainties and other factors affecting forward-looking statements in the Risk Factors section that appears in
Item 3.D. “Key Information-Risk Factors.”
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
PART I
1
ITEM 1.
IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS
1
ITEM 2.
OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE
1
ITEM 3.
KEY INFORMATION
1
A.
[Reserved]
1
B.
Capitalization and Indebtedness
1
C.
Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds
1
D.
Risk Factors
1
ITEM 4.
INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY
24
A.
History and Development of the Company
24
B.
Business Overview
25
C.
Organizational Structure
36
D.
Property, Plant and Equipment
36
ITEM 4A.
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
37
ITEM 5.
OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS
37
A.
Operating Results
37
B.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
41
C.
Research and Development, Patents and Licenses
42
D.
Trend Information
43
E.
Critical Accounting Estimates
43
ITEM 6.
DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES
45
A.
Directors and Senior Management
45
B.
Compensation
48
C.
Board Practices
55
D.
Employees
57
E.
Share Ownership
58
F.
Disclosure of a registrant’s action to recover erroneously awarded compensation
62
ITEM 7.
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
62
A.
Major Shareholders
62
B.
Related Party Transactions
62
C.
Interests of Experts and Counsel
62
ITEM 8.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
63
A.
Financial Statements and Other Financial Information
63
B.
Significant Changes
63
ITEM 9.
THE OFFER AND LISTING
63
A.
Offer and Listing Details
63
B.
Plan of Distribution
63
C.
Markets
63
D.
Selling Shareholders
64
E.
Dilution
64
F.
Expenses of the Issue
64
i
ITEM 10.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
64
A.
Share Capital
64
B.
Memorandum and Articles of Association
64
C.
Material Contracts
65
D.
Exchange Controls
65
E.
Taxation
65
F.
Dividends and Paying Agents
72
G.
Statement by Experts
72
H.
Documents on Display
72
I.
Subsidiary Information
72
J.
Annual Report to Security Holders
72
ITEM 11.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
72
ITEM 12.
DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES
73
PART II
74
ITEM 13.
DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES
74
ITEM 14.
MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
74
ITEM 15.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
74
ITEM 16.
RESERVED
75
ITEM 16A.
AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT
75
ITEM 16B.
CODE OF ETHICS
75
ITEM 16C.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
75
ITEM 16D.
EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES
75
ITEM 16E.
PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS
75
ITEM 16F.
CHANGES IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT
76
ITEM 16G.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
76
ITEM 16H.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE
76
ITEM 16I
DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS
76
ITEM 16J
INSIDER TRADING POLICIES
76
ITEM 16K
CYBER SECURITY
76
PART III
78
ITEM 17.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
78
ITEM 18.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
78
CONSOLIDATED ENTITY DISCLOSURE STATEMENT
79
ITEM 19.
EXHIBITS
81
SIGNATURES
82
ii
PART I
ITEM 1. IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS
Not applicable.
ITEM 2. OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE
Not applicable.
ITEM 3. KEY INFORMATION
A.
[RESERVED]
B.
CAPITALIZATION AND INDEBTEDNESS
Not applicable.
C.
REASONS FOR THE OFFER AND USE OF PROCEEDS
Not applicable.
D.
RISK FACTORS
Investing in our securities involves a high degree of risk and uncertainty. You should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described
below before investing in our securities. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we believe to be immaterial may also
adversely affect our business. If any of the following risks actually occurs, our business, prospects, financial condition and results of operations could be
harmed. In that case, the daily price of our securities could decline, and you could lose all or part of your investment. These risk factors include:
Risks Related to Our Financial Condition
●
We have a history of operating losses and our management has concluded that factors raise substantial doubt about our ability to continue as
a going concern and our auditor has included an explanatory paragraph relating to our ability to continue as a going concern in its audit
report for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2024.
●
We will need additional funding to operate our business; such funding may not be available or, if it is available, such financing is likely to
substantially dilute our existing shareholders.
Risks Related to Our Business
●
We are a development stage company engaged in the development of pharmaceutical products and our success in uncertain.
●
We rely on research institutions to conduct our clinical trials and we may not be able to secure and maintain research institutions to conduct
our future trials. The institutions that we work with have their own limits and procedures that will influence or limit our ability to conduct
research and development and the conduct of clinical trials.
●
We are faced with uncertainties related to our research.
●
Clinical trials as they relate to our business are expensive and time consuming and their outcome is uncertain.
●
We may experience delays in our clinical trials that could adversely affect our business and operations.
1
●
We may not be able to complete the development of our products candidates or develop other pharmaceutical products.
●
We may need to prioritise the development of our most promising candidates at the expense of the development of other products.
●
Our research and development efforts will be seriously jeopardised if we are unable to retain key personnel and cultivate key academic and
scientific collaborations.
●
If we are unable to successfully keep pace with technological change or with the advances of our competitors, our technology and products
may become obsolete or non-competitive.
●
Acceptance of our products in the marketplace is uncertain and failure to achieve market acceptance will negatively impact our business and
operations.
●
We have limited large scale manufacturing experience with our product candidates. Delays in manufacturing sufficient quantities of such
materials to the required standards for non-clinical and clinical development may negatively impact our business and operations.
●
The failure to establish sales, marketing and distribution capability would materially impair our ability to successfully market and sell our
pharmaceutical products.
●
If healthcare insurers and other organisations do not pay for our products, or impose limits on reimbursement, our future business may
suffer.
●
We may be exposed to product liability claims, which could harm our business.
●
Breaches of network or information technology security, natural disasters or terrorist attacks could have an adverse effect on our business.
Risks Related to Government Regulation
●
If we do not obtain the necessary governmental approvals, we will be unable to develop or commercialise our pharmaceutical products.
●
We will not be able to commercialise any current or future product candidates if we fail to adequately demonstrate their safety and efficacy.
●
Positive results in previous clinical trials of product candidates may not be replicated in future clinical trials, which could result in
development delays or a failure to obtain marketing approval.
●
Even if approved, any product candidates that we or our subsidiaries may develop and market may be later withdrawn from the market or
subject to promotional limitations.
●
Healthcare reform measures and other statutory or regulatory changes could adversely affect our business.
●
We could be adversely affected by violations of the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act.
2
Risks Related to Intellectual Property
●
Our success depends upon our ability to protect our intellectual property and our proprietary technology, to operate without infringing the
proprietary rights of third parties and to obtain marketing exclusivity for our products and technologies.
●
We may face difficulties in certain jurisdictions in protecting our intellectual property rights, which may diminish the value of our
intellectual property rights in those jurisdictions.
●
Intellectual property rights do not address all potential threats to our competitive advantage.
●
Changes in patent laws or patent jurisprudence could diminish the value of our patents, thereby impairing our ability to protect our products
or product candidates.
●
Confidentiality agreements with employees and others may not adequately prevent disclosure of our trade secrets and protect our other
proprietary information.
Risks Related to Our Compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
●
We may fail to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting in accordance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of
2002, which could adversely affect our operating results, investor confidence in our reported financial information, and the market price of
our ordinary shares and ADSs.
●
Material weaknesses in our disclosure controls and procedures could negatively affect shareholder and customer confidence.
Risks Related to Ownership of Our Securities
●
Our stock price may be volatile and the trading markets for our securities is limited.
●
Ownership interest in our company may be further diluted as a result of additional financings.
●
There is a substantial risk that we are a passive foreign investment company, or PFIC, to some U.S. investors which will subject those
investors to adverse tax rules
●
We do not anticipate paying dividends on our ordinary shares.
●
Currency fluctuations may adversely affect the price of our securities.
●
If we fail to maintain compliance with NASDAQ’s continued listing requirements, our shares may be delisted from the NASDAQ Capital
Market.
Risks Related to Our Location in Australia
●
It may be difficult to enforce a judgment in the United States against us and our officers and directors or to assert U.S. securities laws claims
in Australia or serve process on our officers and directors.
●
As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed on The NASDAQ Capital Market, we may follow certain home country corporate
governance practices instead of certain NASDAQ requirements.
●
We currently do not have a majority of independent directors serving on our Board of Directors, which may afford less protection to our
shareholders than if our Board of Directors had a majority of independent directors.
●
Australian takeovers laws may discourage takeover offers being made for us or may discourage the acquisition of large numbers of our
ordinary shares.
●
Our Constitution and other Australian laws and regulations applicable to us may adversely affect our ability to take actions that could be
beneficial to our shareholders.
3
Risks Related to Our Financial Condition
We have a history of operating losses and our management has concluded that factors raise substantial doubt about our ability to
continue as a going concern and our auditor has included an explanatory paragraph relating to our ability to continue as a going concern in its
audit report for the fiscal year ended June 30, 2024.
We have not sufficiently advanced the development of any of our product candidates to market or generate revenues from their commercial
application and have incurred losses in every period since we began operations in 1997 and reported net losses of A$19,123,464, A$13,806,515 and
A$12,847,061 during the fiscal years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022 respectively. As of June 30, 2024, our accumulated deficit was
A$214,161,131. We expect to continue incurring losses into the foreseeable future and will need to raise additional capital to continue the development of
our planned research and development programs, and as a result, this creates a material uncertainty that casts significant doubt (or raises substantial doubt
as contemplated by Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) standards) on our ability to continue as a going concern and, therefore,
that we may be unable to realize our assets and discharge our liabilities in the normal course of business. Our actual cash requirements may vary
materially from those now planned and will depend upon numerous factors, including:
●
the continued progress of our research and development programs;
●
the timing, scope, results and costs of nonclinical studies and clinical trials;
●
the cost, timing and outcome of regulatory submissions and approvals;
●
determinations as to the commercial potential of our product candidates;
●
our ability to successfully expand our contract manufacturing activities,
●
the cost of corporate overheads, including listed fees;
●
our ability to establish and maintain collaborative arrangements; and
●
the status and timing of competitive developments.
If we fail to generate revenue and eventually become and remain profitable, or if we are unable to fund our continuing losses, our shareholders
could lose all or part of their investments.
We will need additional funding to operate our business; such funding may not be available or, if it is available, such financing is likely
to substantially dilute our existing shareholders.
During the year ended June 30, 2024 we raised A$10,144,682 from the sale of our ordinary shares. We will need to secure additional financing
in order to continue to meet our longer-term business objectives, including advancement of our research and development programs and we may also
require additional funds to pursue regulatory clearances, defend our intellectual property rights, establish commercial scale manufacturing facilities,
develop marketing and sales capabilities and fund operating expenses. We intend to seek such additional funding through public or private financings
and/or through licensing of our assets or strategic alliances or other arrangements with corporate partners.
Until we can generate a sufficient amount of product revenue to finance our cash requirements, which we may never achieve, we expect to
finance our cash needs primarily through public or private equity offerings, debt financings or through strategic alliances. We cannot be certain that
additional funding will be available on acceptable terms or at all. If we are not able to secure additional funding when needed, we may have to delay,
reduce the scope of, or eliminate one or more of our clinical trials, collaborative research or development programs or future commercialisation
initiatives. In addition, any additional funding that we do obtain will dilute the ownership held by our existing security holders. The amount of this
dilution may be substantially increased if the trading price of our shares is lower at the time of any financing. Regardless, the economic dilution to
shareholders will be significant if our stock price does not increase significantly, or if the effective price of any sale is below the price paid by a particular
shareholder. Any debt financing could involve substantial restrictions on activities and creditors could seek a pledge of some or all of our assets. We have
not identified potential sources for the additional financing that we will require, and we do not have commitments from any third parties to provide any
future financing. If we fail to obtain additional funding as needed, we may be forced to cease or scale back operations, and our results, financial condition
and stock price would be adversely affected.
4
Risks Related to Our Business
We rely on research institutions to conduct our clinical trials and we may not be able to secure and maintain research institutions to
conduct our future trials. The institutions that we work with have their own limits and procedures that may influence or limit our ability to
conduct research and development and the conduct of clinical trials.
Our reliance upon research institutions, including public and private hospitals and clinics, provides us with less control over the timing and cost
of clinical trials, clinical study management personnel and the ability to recruit subjects. If we are unable to reach agreements with suitable research
institutions on acceptable terms, or if any resulting agreement is terminated, we may be unable to secure, maintain or quickly replace the research
institution with another qualified institution on acceptable terms.
We are faced with uncertainties related to our research.
Our research programs are based on scientific hypotheses and experimental approaches that may not lead to desired results. In addition, the
timeframe for obtaining proof of principle and other results may be considerably longer than originally anticipated, or may not be possible given time,
resource, financial, strategic and collaborator scientific constraints. Success in one stage of testing is not necessarily an indication that a particular
program will succeed in later stages of testing and development. It is not possible to predict whether any of the candidate products designed for these
programs will prove to be safe, effective, and suitable for human use. Each candidate product will require additional research and development, scale-up,
formulation and extensive clinical testing in humans. Unsatisfactory results obtained from any of these activities relating to a program may cause us to
abandon our commitment to that program or product candidate being tested. The discovery of toxicities, lack of sufficient efficacy, unacceptable
pharmacology, inability to increase scale of manufacture, market attractiveness, regulatory hurdles, competition, as well as other factors, may make our
targets, lead therapies or product candidates unattractive for further development or unsuitable for human use, and we may abandon our commitment to
that program, target, or product candidate.
Clinical trials as they relate to our business are expensive and time consuming and their outcome is uncertain.
In order to obtain approvals to market a new drug product, we or our potential partners must demonstrate proof of safety and efficacy in humans.
To meet these requirements, we or our potential partners will have to conduct extensive non-clinical testing and “adequate and well-controlled” clinical
trials. Conducting clinical trials is a lengthy, time-consuming and expensive process. The length of time may vary substantially according to the type,
complexity, novelty and intended use of the product candidate, and often can be several years or more per trial. Even if we obtain positive results from
such non-clinical or initial clinical trials, we may not achieve the same success in future trials. Clinical trials may not demonstrate adequate safety or
sufficient effectiveness to obtain the requisite regulatory approvals for product candidates employing our technology. The failure of clinical trials to
demonstrate safety and efficacy for a particular desired indication could harm development of that product candidate for other indications as well as other
product candidates.
We expect to commence new clinical trials from time to time as our product development work continues. Any change in, or termination of, our
clinical trials could materially harm our business, financial condition and results of operations.
5
We may experience delays in our clinical trials that could adversely affect our business and operations.
We do not know whether planned clinical trials will begin on time or whether we will complete any of our clinical trials on schedule or at all.
Our ability to commence and complete clinical trials may be delayed by many factors, including:
●
government or regulatory delays, including delays in obtaining approvals from applicable hospital ethics committees and internal review
boards;
●
slower than expected patient enrollment;
●
our inability to manufacture sufficient quantities of our new proprietary compound or our other product candidates or matching controls;
●
unforeseen safety issues; or
●
lack of efficacy or unacceptable toxicity during the clinical trials or non-clinical studies.
Patient enrollment is a function of, among other things, the nature of the clinical trial protocol, the existence of competing protocols, the size and
longevity of the target patient population, and the availability of patients who comply with the eligibility criteria for the clinical trial. Delays in planned
patient enrollment may result in increased costs, delays or termination of the clinical trials. Moreover, we rely on third parties such as clinical research
organisations to assist us in clinical trial management functions including; clinical trial database management, statistical analyses, site management and
monitoring. Any failure by these third parties to perform under their agreements with us may cause the trials to be delayed or result in a failure to
complete the trials.
If we experience delays in testing or approvals or if we need to perform more, larger or more complex clinical trials than planned, our product
development costs will likely increase. Significant delays could adversely affect the commercial prospects of our product candidates and our business,
financial condition and results of operations.
We may not be able to complete the development of our product candidates or develop other pharmaceutical products.
We may not be able to progress with the development of our current or any future pharmaceutical product candidates to a stage that will attract a
suitable collaborative partner for the development of any current or future pharmaceutical product candidates. The projects initially specified in
connection with any such collaboration and any associated funding may change or be discontinued as a result of changing interests of either the
collaborator or us, and any such change may change the budget for the projects under the collaboration. Additionally, our research may not lead to the
discovery of additional product candidates, and any of our current and future product candidates may not be successfully developed, prove to be safe and
efficacious in clinical trials, meet applicable regulatory standards and receive regulatory approval, be capable of being produced in commercial quantities
at reasonable costs, or be successfully or profitably marketed, either by us or a collaborative partner. The products we develop may not be able to
penetrate the potential market for a particular therapy or indication or gain market acceptance among health care providers, patients and third-party
payers. We cannot predict if or when the development of our current product candidates or any future product candidates will be completed or
commercialised, whether funded by us, as part of a collaboration or through a grant.
6
We may need to prioritise the development of our most promising candidates at the expense of the development of other products.
We may need to prioritise the allocation of development resources and/or funds towards what we believe to be our most promising candidate
product or products. The nature of the drug development process is such that there is a constant availability of new information and data which could
positively or adversely affect a product in development. We cannot predict how such new information and data may impact in the future the prioritisation
of the development of our current or future product candidates or that any of our products, regardless of its development stage or the investment of time
and funds in its development, will continue to be funded or developed.
Our research and development efforts will be seriously jeopardised if we are unable to retain key personnel and cultivate key academic
and scientific collaborations.
Our future success depends to a large extent on the continued services of our senior management and key scientific personnel. We have entered
into employment or consultancy agreements with these individuals. The loss of their services could negatively affect our business. Competition among
biotechnology and pharmaceutical companies for qualified employees is intense, including competition from larger companies with greater resources, and
we may not be able to continue to attract and retain qualified management, technical and scientific personnel critical to our success. Our success is highly
dependent on our ability to develop and maintain important relationships with leading academic institutions and scientists who conduct research at our
request or assist us in formulating our research and development strategies. These academic and scientific collaborators are not our employees and may
have commitments to, or consulting or advisory contracts with, other entities that may limit their availability to us. In addition, these collaborators may
have arrangements with other companies to assist such companies in developing technologies that may prove competitive to ours.
If we are unable to successfully keep pace with technological change or with the advances of our competitors, our technology and
products may become obsolete or non-competitive.
The biotechnology and pharmaceutical industries are subject to rapid and significant technological change. Our competitors are numerous and
include major pharmaceutical companies, biotechnology firms, universities and other research institutions. These competitors may develop technologies
and products that are more effective than any that we are developing, or which would render our technology and products obsolete or non-competitive.
Many of these competitors have greater financial and technical resources and manufacturing and marketing capabilities than we do. In addition, many of
our competitors have much more experience than we do in pre-clinical testing and human clinical trials of new or improved drugs, as well as in obtaining
regulatory approvals.
We know that competitors are developing or manufacturing various technologies or products for the treatment of diseases that we have targeted
for product development. Some of these competitive products use therapeutic approaches that compete directly with our product candidates. Our ability to
further develop our products may be adversely affected if any of our competitors were to succeed in obtaining regulatory approval for their competitive
products sooner than us.
Acceptance of our products in the marketplace is uncertain, and failure to achieve market acceptance will negatively impact our
business and operations.
Our current or future candidate products may not achieve market acceptance even if they are approved by regulatory authorities. The degree of
market acceptance of such products will depend on a number of factors, including:
●
the receipt and timing of regulatory approvals for the uses that we are studying;
●
the establishment and demonstration to the medical community of the safety, clinical efficacy or cost-effectiveness of our product
candidates and their potential advantages over existing therapeutics and technologies; and
●
the pricing and reimbursement policies of governments and third-party payors.
Physicians, patients, payors or the medical community in general may be unwilling to accept, use or recommend any of our products.
7
We lack the resources to manufacture any of our product candidates and rely on collaborators and third party contractors. Delays in
manufacturing sufficient quantities of such materials to the required standards for pre-clinical and clinical trials may negatively impact our
business and operations.
We lack the resources to manufacture any of our product candidates on a clinical or commercial scale and do not currently have, nor do we plan
to acquire the infrastructure or capability internally to manufacture our clinical drug supplies for use in the conduct of our clinical trials. We rely on
collaborators and/or third parties for development, scale-up, formulation, optimisation, management of clinical trial and commercial scale manufacturing
and commercialisation. There are no assurances we can scale-up, formulate or manufacture any product candidate in sufficient quantities with acceptable
specifications for the conduct of our clinical trials or for the regulatory agencies to grant approval of such product candidate. We have not yet
commercialized any products and have no commercial manufacturing experience. To be successful, our products must be properly formulated, scalable,
stable and safely manufactured in clinical trial and commercial quantities in compliance with good manufacturing practices (“GMP”) and other regulatory
requirements and at acceptable costs. Should any of our suppliers or our collaborators be unable to supply or be delayed in supplying us with sufficient
supplies, no assurance can be given that we will be able to find alternative means of supply in a short period of time. Should such parties’ operations
suffer a material adverse event, the manufacturing of our products would also be adversely affected. Furthermore, key raw materials could become scarce
or unavailable. We may not be able to meet specifications previously established for product candidates during scale-up and manufacturing.
There may be a limited number of third parties who can manufacture our products. Our reliance on third parties to manufacture our product
candidates will expose us and our partners to risks including the following, any of which could delay or prevent the commercialisation of our products,
result in higher costs, or deprive us of potential product revenue:
●
Contract manufacturers can encounter difficulties in achieving the scale-up, optimisation, formulation, or volume production of a compound
as well as maintaining quality control with appropriate quality assurance. They may also experience shortages of qualified personnel.
Contract manufacturers are required to undergo a satisfactory GMP inspection prior to regulatory approval and are obliged to operate in
accordance with the U.S. Food & Drug Administration (“FDA”), International Conference on Harmonisation of Technical Requirements for
Registration of Pharmaceuticals for Human Use (“ICH”), European and other nationally mandated GMP regulations and/or guidelines
governing manufacturing processes, stability testing, record keeping and quality standards. A failure of these contract manufacturers to
follow GMP and to document their adherence to such practices or failure of an inspection by a regulatory agency may lead to significant
delays in the availability of our product candidate materials for clinical study, leading to delays in our trials.
●
For each of our current product candidates we will initially rely on a limited number of contract manufacturers. Changing these or
identifying future manufacturers may be difficult. Changing manufacturers requires re-validation of the manufacturing processes and
procedures in accordance with FDA, ICH, European and other mandated GMP regulations and/or guidelines. Such re-validation may be
costly and time-consuming. It may be difficult or impossible for us to quickly find replacement manufacturers on acceptable terms, if at all.
●
Our contract manufacturers may not perform as agreed or may not remain in the contract manufacturing business for the time required to
produce, store and distribute our products successfully.
8
The failure to establish sales, marketing and distribution capability would materially impair our ability to successfully market and sell
our pharmaceutical products.
We currently have no experience in marketing, sales or distribution of pharmaceutical products. If we develop any commercially marketable
pharmaceutical products and decide to perform our own sales and marketing activities, we will require additional management, will need to hire sales and
marketing personnel and will require additional capital. Qualified personnel may not be available in adequate numbers or at a reasonable cost. Further,
our sales staff may not achieve success in their marketing efforts. Alternatively, we may be required to enter into marketing arrangements with other
parties who have established appropriate marketing, sales and distribution capabilities. We may not be able to enter into marketing arrangements with any
marketing partner, or if such arrangements are established, our marketing partners may not be able to commercialise our products successfully. Other
companies offering similar or substitute products may have well-established and well-funded marketing and sales operations in place that will allow them
to market their products more successfully. Failure to establish sufficient marketing capabilities would materially impair our ability to successfully
market and sell our pharmaceutical products.
If healthcare insurers and other organisations do not pay for the products we hope to develop, or impose limits on reimbursement, our
future business may suffer.
The drugs we hope to develop may be rejected by the marketplace due to many factors, including cost. The continuing efforts of governments,
insurance companies, health maintenance organisations and other payors of healthcare costs to contain or reduce healthcare costs may affect our future
revenues and profitability and those of our potential customers, suppliers and collaborative partners, as well as the availability of capital. In Australia and
certain foreign markets, the pricing or profitability of prescription pharmaceuticals is already subject to government control. We expect initiatives for
similar government control at both the state and federal level to continue in the United States and elsewhere. The adoption of any such legislative or
regulatory proposals could adversely affect our business and prospects.
Our ability to commercially exploit our products successfully will depend in part on the extent to which reimbursement for the cost of our
products and related treatment will be available from government health administration authorities, private health coverage insurers and other
organisations. Third-party payors, such as government and private health insurers, are increasingly challenging the price of medical products and
services. Uncertainty exists as to the reimbursement status of newly approved health care products and in foreign markets, including the United States. If
third-party coverage is not available to patients for any of the products we develop, alone or with collaborators, the market acceptance of these products
may be reduced, which may adversely affect our future revenues and profitability. In addition, cost containment legislation and reductions in government
insurance programs may result in lower prices for our products and could materially adversely affect our ability to operate profitably.
We may be exposed to product liability claims, which could harm our business.
The testing, marketing and sale of human health care products also entails an inherent risk of product liability. We may incur substantial
liabilities or be required to limit development or commercialisation of our candidate products if we cannot successfully defend ourselves against product
liability claims. We have historically obtained no fault compensation insurance for our clinical trials and intend to obtain similar coverage for future
clinical trials. Such coverage may not be available in the future on acceptable terms, or at all. This may result in our inability to pursue further clinical
trials or to obtain adequate protection in the event of a successful claim. We may not be able to obtain product liability insurance in the event of the
commercialisation of a candidate product or such insurance may not be available on commercially reasonable terms. Even if we have adequate insurance
coverage, product liability claims or recalls could result in negative publicity or force us to devote significant time, attention and financial resources to
those matters.
9
Breaches of network or information technology security, natural disasters or terrorist attacks could have an adverse effect on our
business.
Our business and operations would suffer in the event of IT system failures, cybersecurity attacks, data breaches, or vulnerabilities in our or our
third-party vendors’ information security program or defenses.
Our business relies upon information technology systems operated by us and by our third-party service providers. These systems may fail or
experience operational disruption, experience cybersecurity attacks, or be damaged by computer viruses and unauthorized access. In the ordinary course
of business, we collect, store and transmit confidential information (including but not limited to intellectual property, proprietary business information
and personal information). It is critical that we do so in a secure manner to maintain the confidentiality and integrity of such confidential information. If
we fail to develop and maintain adequate policies and procedures for the protection of our information technology systems and confidential and
proprietary information, we may be vulnerable to security breaches or disruptions and system breakdowns or other damage or interruptions.
We also have outsourced elements of our operations to third parties, and as a result we manage a number of third-party vendors and other
contractors and consultants who have access to or store our confidential information. We do not conduct audits or formal evaluations of our third-party
vendors’ information technology systems and cannot be sure that our third-party vendors have sufficient measures in place to ensure the security and
integrity of their information technology systems and our confidential and proprietary information. If our third-party vendors fail to protect their
information technology systems and our confidential and proprietary information, we may be vulnerable to disruptions in service and unauthorized access
to our confidential or proprietary information and we could incur liability and reputational damage and the further development and commercialization of
our product candidates could be delayed.
We have been subject, and will likely continue to be subject, to attempts to breach the security of our networks and IT infrastructure through
cyber-attack, malware, computer viruses and other means of unauthorised access. However, to date, we have not been subject to cyber-attacks or other
cyber incidents which, individually or in the aggregate, resulted in a material impact to our operations or financial condition. We cannot assure you that
our data protection efforts and our investment in information technology will prevent significant breakdowns, data leakages, breaches in our systems or
those of our third-party vendors and other contractors and consultants, or other cyber incidents that could have a material adverse effect upon our
reputation, business, operations or financial condition. Furthermore, cyberattacks and security incidents are expected to accelerate in both frequency and
impact as the use of AI increases and attackers become increasingly sophisticated and utilize tools and techniques that are designed to circumvent
controls, avoid detection, and remove or obfuscate forensic evidence.
If such an event were to occur and cause interruptions in our operations, it could result in a material disruption of our development programs,
business operations, a breach of sensitive personal information or a loss or corruption of critical data assets including trade secrets or other proprietary
information. For example, the loss of clinical trial data from future clinical trials could result in delays in our regulatory approval efforts and significantly
increase our costs to recover or reproduce the data. Such IT system failures, cybersecurity attacks or vulnerabilities to our or our third-party vendors’
information security programs or defenses could result in legal liability, reputational damage, business interruption, and our competitive position could be
harmed and the further development and commercialization of our products or any future products could be delayed or disrupted. Moreover, containing
and remediating any IT system failure, cybersecurity attack or vulnerability may require significant investment of resources. Furthermore, significant
security breaches or disruptions of our internal information technology systems or those of our third-party vendors and other contractors and consultants
could result in the loss, misappropriation and/or unauthorized access, use, or disclosure of, or the prevention of access to, confidential information
(including trade secrets or other intellectual property, proprietary business information and personal information), which could result in financial, legal,
business and reputational harm to us.
10
We and the third parties with whom we work are subject to stringent and evolving U.S. and foreign laws, regulations, rules, contractual
obligations, industry standards, policies and other obligations related to data privacy and security. Our actual or perceived failure to comply
with such obligations (or that of the third parties with whom we work) could lead to regulatory investigations or actions; litigation (including
class actions); mass arbitration demands; fines and penalties; a disruption of our business operations; reputational harm; loss of revenue or
profits; and other adverse business consequences.
In the ordinary course of business, we collect, receive, store, process, generate, use, transfer, disclose, make accessible, protect, secure, dispose
of, transmit, and share (collectively, “process”) personal data and other sensitive information including proprietary and confidential business data. trade
secrets. intellectual property, data we collect about trial participants in connection with clinical trials. and other sensitive third-party data. Our data
processing activities subject us to numerous data privacy and security obligations. such as various laws, regulations guidance, industry standards, external
and internal privacy and security policies, contractual requirements, and other obligations relating to data privacy and security.
In the United States, federal, state, and local governments have enacted numerous data privacy and security laws, including data breach
notification laws. personal data privacy laws, consumer protection laws (e.g. Section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act), and other similar laws
(e.g., wiretapping laws). For example HIPAA, as amended by HITECH, imposes specific requirements relating to the privacy, security, and transmission
of individually identifiable health information. In the past few years, numerous U.S. states-including California, Virginia, Colorado, Connecticut, and
Utah-have enacted comprehensive privacy laws that impose certain obligations on covered businesses, including providing specific disclosures in privacy
notices and affording residents with certain rights concerning their personal data. As applicable, such rights may include the right to access, correct, or
delete certain personal data, and to opt-out of certain data processing activities, such as targeted advertising, profiling, and automated decision-making.
The exercise of these rights may impact our business and ability to provide our products and services. Certain states also impose stricter requirements for
processing certain personal data, including sensitive information, such as conducting data privacy impact assessments. These state laws allow for
statutory fines for noncompliance. For example, the California Consumer Privacy Act of 2018 (“CCPA”) applies to personal data of consumers, business
representatives, and employees, and requires businesses to provide specific disclosures in privacy notices and honor requests of California residents to
exercise certain privacy rights. The CCPA provides for civil penalties of up to $7,500 per violation and allows private litigants affected by certain data
breaches to recover significant statutory damages. Similar laws are being considered in several other states, as well as at the federal and local levels, and
we expect more states to pass similar laws in the future.
The CCPA and other comprehensive U.S. state privacy laws exempt some data processed in the context of clinical trials, but these developments
may further complicate compliance efforts and increase legal risk and compliance costs for us and the third parties with whom we work.
Outside the United States, an increasing number of laws, regulations, and industry standards govern data privacy and security. For example, the
European Union’s General Data Protection Regulation (“EU GDPR”), the United Kingdom’s GDPR (“UK GDPR”)(collectively, “GDPR”), Brazil’s
General Data Protection Law (Lei Geral de Protecão de Dados Pessoais, or “LGPD”) (Law No. 13,709/2018), and China’s Personal Information
Protection Law (“PIPL”) impose strict requirements for processing personal data. For example, under the GDPR, companies may face temporary or
definitive bans on data processing and other corrective actions, fines of up to 20 million Euros / 17.5 million pounds sterling, or 4% of annual global
revenue, whichever is greater; or private litigation related to processing of personal data brought by classes of data subjects or consumer protection
organizations authorized at law to represent their interests. China’s PIPL imposes a set of specific obligations on covered businesses in connection with
their processing and transfer of personal data and imposes fines of up to RMB 50 million or 5% of the prior year’s total annual revenue of the violator. In
Canada, the Personal Information Protection and Electronic Documents Act (“PIPEDA”) and various related provincial laws, as well as Canada’s Anti-
Spam Legislation (“CASL”), may apply to our operations. We may be subject to new and emerging data privacy and security regimes, including
Australia’s Privacy Act China’s Personal Information Protection Law, Japan’s Act on the Protection of Personal Information, and Singapore’s Personal
Data Protection Act.
11
In the ordinary course of business. we may transfer personal data from Europe and other jurisdictions to the United States or other countries.
Europe and other jurisdictions have enacted laws requiring data to be localized or limiting the transfer of personal data to other countries. In particular,
the European Economic Area (“EEA”) and the United Kingdom (“UK”) have significantly restricted the transfer of personal data to the United States and
other countries whose privacy laws it believes are inadequate. Other jurisdictions may adopt similarly stringent interpretations of their data localization
and cross-border data transfer laws. Although there are currently various mechanisms that may be used to transfer personal data from the EEA and UK to
the United States in compliance with law, such as the EEA standard contractual clauses, the UK’s International Data Transfer Agreement / Addendum,
and the EU-U.S. Data Privacy Framework and the UK extension thereto (which allows for transfers to relevant U.S.-based organizations who self-certify
compliance and participate in the Framework), these mechanisms are subject to legal challenges, and there is no assurance that we can satisfy or rely on
these measures to lawfully transfer personal data to the United States. If there is no lawful manner for us to transfer personal data from the EEA, the UK
or other jurisdictions to the United States, or if the requirements for a legally-compliant transfer are too onerous, we could face significant adverse
consequences, including the interruption or degradation of our operations, the need to relocate part of or all of our business or data processing activities to
other jurisdictions at significant expense, increased exposure to regulatory actions, substantial fines and penalties, the inability to transfer data and work
with partners. vendors and other third parties, and injunctions against our processing or transferring of personal data necessary to operate our business.
Additionally, companies that transfer personal data out of the EEA and UK to other jurisdictions, particularly to the United States, are subject to increased
scrutiny from regulators, individual litigants, and activist groups. Some European regulators have ordered certain companies to suspend or permanently
cease certain transfers out of Europe for allegedly violating the GDPR’s cross-border data transfer limitations.
Our employees and personnel may use generative artificial intelligence (“AI”) technologies to perform their work, and the disclosure and use of
personal data in generative AI technologies is subject to various privacy laws and other privacy obligations. Governments have passed and are likely to
pass additional laws regulating generative AI. Our use of this technology could result in additional compliance costs, regulatory investigations and
actions, and lawsuits. If we are unable to use generative AI, it could make our business less efficient and result in competitive disadvantages.
In addition to data privacy and security laws, we are or may become contractually subject to industry standards adopted by industry groups. We
are also bound by contractual obligations related to data privacy and
security. and our efforts to comply with such obligations may not be successful. For example, certain data privacy laws. such as the GDPR and the
CCPA, require covered businesses to impose specific contractual restrictions on their service providers. We publish privacy policies, marketing materials
and other statements, such as compliance with certain certifications or self-regulatory principles, regarding data privacy and security. If these policies.
materials or statements are found to be deficient, lacking in transparency. deceptive, unfair, or misrepresentative of our practices, we may be subject to
investigation, enforcement actions by regulators or other adverse consequences.
Obligations related to data privacy and security (and consumers’ data privacy expectations) are quickly changing, becoming increasingly
stringent, and creating uncertainty. Additionally, these obligations may be subject to differing applications and interpretations, which may be inconsistent
or conflict among jurisdictions. Preparing for and complying with these obligations requires us to devote significant resources, which may necessitate
changes to our services, information technologies, systems, and practices and to those of any third parties with whom we work. In addition, these
obligations may require us to change our business model.
We may at times fail (or be perceived to have failed) in our efforts to comply with our data privacy and security obligations. Moreover, despite
our efforts, our personnel or third parties with whom we work may fail to comply with such obligations, which could negatively impact our business
operations. If we or the third parties with whom we work fail, or are perceived to have failed, to address or comply with applicable data privacy and
security obligations, we could face significant consequences, including but not limited to: government enforcement actions (e.g., investigations, fines,
penalties, audits, inspections, and similar); litigation (including class-action claims) or mass arbitration demands; additional reporting requirements and/or
oversight; bans on processing personal data; orders to destroy or not use personal data; and imprisonment of company officials.
Any of these events could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, or financial condition including but not limited to: loss of
customers; interruptions or stoppages in our business operations (including clinical trials); inability to process personal data or to operate in certain
jurisdictions; limited ability to develop or commercialize our products; expenditure of time and resources to defend any claim or inquiry; adverse
publicity, or substantial changes to our business model or operations.
12
Risks Related to Government Regulation
If we do not obtain the necessary governmental approvals, we will be unable to develop or commercialise our pharmaceutical products.
Our ongoing research and development activities are, and the production and marketing of our pharmaceutical product candidates derived from
such activities will be, subject to regulation by numerous international regulatory authorities. Prior to marketing, any therapeutic product developed must
undergo rigorous pre-clinical testing and clinical trials and, to the extent that any of our pharmaceutical products under development are marketed abroad,
by the relevant international regulatory authorities. For example, in Australia, principally the Therapeutics Goods Administration, or TGA; the Food and
Drug Administration, or FDA, in the United States; the Medicines and Healthcare products Regulatory Agency, or MHRA, in the United Kingdom; the
Medical Products Agency, or MPA, in Sweden; and the European Medicines Agency, or EMA. These processes can take many years and require the
expenditure of substantial resources. Governmental authorities may not grant regulatory approval due to matters arising from pre-clinical animal
toxicology, safety pharmacology, drug formulation and purity, insufficient efficacy, clinical side effects or patient risk profiles, or medical
contraindications.
Failure or delay in obtaining regulatory approvals would adversely affect the development and commercialisation of our pharmaceutical product
candidates. We may not be able to obtain the clearances and approvals necessary for clinical testing or for manufacturing and marketing our
pharmaceutical product candidates.
Even if regulatory authorities approve any of our product candidates, the manufacture, labeling, storage, recordkeeping, reporting, distribution,
advertising, promotion, marketing, sale, import and export of these drugs will be subject to strict and ongoing regulation. If we, our partners, our product
candidates or the manufacturing facilities for our product candidates fail to comply with applicable regulatory requirements, a regulatory agency may
suspend any ongoing clinical trials; issue warning letters or untitled letters; suspend or withdraw regulatory approval; refuse to approve pending
applications or supplements to applications; suspend or impose restrictions on operations; seize or detain products, prohibit the export or import of
products, or require us to initiate a product recall; seek other monetary or injunctive remedies; or impose civil or criminal penalties.
We will not be able to commercialise any current or future product candidates if we fail to adequately demonstrate their safety and
efficacy.
Before obtaining regulatory approvals for the commercial sale of any of our pharmaceutical products, we must demonstrate through pre-clinical
testing and clinical studies that our product candidates are safe and effective for use in humans for each target indication. Results from early clinical trials
may not be predictive of results obtained in large-scale, later-stage clinical testing. Even though a candidate product shows promising results in clinical
trials, regulatory authorities may not grant the necessary approvals without sufficient safety and efficacy data.
We may not be able to undertake further clinical trials of our current and future product candidates as therapies for Parkinsonian disorders or
other indications or to demonstrate the safety and efficacy or superiority of any of these product candidates over existing therapies or other therapies
under development, or enter into any collaborative arrangement to commercialise our current or future product candidates on terms acceptable to us, or at
all. Clinical trial results that show insufficient safety and efficacy could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
13
Positive results in a clinical trial of a product candidate may not be replicated in future clinical trials, which could result in development
delays or a failure to obtain marketing approval.
Positive results in a clinical trial of a product candidate may not be predictive of similar results in future clinical trials. A number of companies
in the biopharmaceutical industry have suffered significant setbacks in late-stage clinical trials even after achieving promising results in early-stage
development. Accordingly, the results from the completed pre-clinical studies and clinical trials for our product candidates may not be predictive of the
results we may obtain in later stage trials. Our clinical trials may produce negative or inconclusive results, and we may decide, or regulators may require
us, to conduct additional clinical trials. Moreover, clinical data are often susceptible to varying interpretations and analyses, and many companies that
have believed their product candidates performed satisfactorily in pre-clinical studies and clinical trials have nonetheless failed to obtain FDA or EMA
approval for their products.
Even if approved, any product candidates that we or our subsidiaries may develop and market may be later withdrawn from the market
or subject to promotional limitations.
We may not be able to obtain the labeling claims necessary or desirable for the promotion of our product candidates if approved. We may also
be required to undertake post-marketing clinical trials. If the results of such post-marketing studies are not satisfactory or if adverse events or other safety
issues arise after approval, the FDA or a comparable regulatory agency in another country may withdraw marketing authorisation or may condition
continued marketing on commitments from us or our subsidiaries that may be expensive or time consuming to complete. In addition, if we or others
identify adverse side effects after any of our products are on the market, or if manufacturing problems occur, regulatory approval may be withdrawn and
reformulation of our or our subsidiaries’ products, additional clinical trials, changes in labeling of our or our subsidiaries’ products and additional
marketing applications may be required. Any reformulation or labeling changes may limit the marketability of such products if approved.
Healthcare reform measures and other statutory or regulatory changes could adversely affect our business.
In both the United States and certain foreign jurisdictions, there have been a number of legislative and regulatory proposals to change the
healthcare system in ways that could impact our business. For example, the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act and the Health Care and
Education Affordability Reconciliation Act of 2010 (collectively, the “ACA”), enacted in March 2010, substantially changes the way healthcare is
financed by both governmental and private insurers, and significantly impacts the pharmaceutical industry. With regard to pharmaceutical products,
among other things, the ACA is expected to expand and increase industry rebates for drugs covered under Medicaid programs and make changes to the
coverage requirements under the Medicare D program. Legislative and regulatory proposals impacting upon the healthcare system are submitted regularly
and the existing framework in force in various jurisdictions may not apply in the short to long term.
We still cannot fully predict the impact of the ACA on our company as many of the ACA reforms require the promulgation of detailed
regulations implementing the statutory provisions which has not yet been completed.
14
Since its enactment, there have been judicial, executive and Congressional challenges to certain aspects of the ACA. On June 17, 2021, the U.S.
Supreme Court dismissed the most recent judicial challenge to the ACA without specifically ruling on the constitutionality of the ACA. Prior to the
Supreme Court’s decision, President Biden issued an executive order to initiate a special enrollment period from February 15, 2021 through August 15,
2021 for purposes of obtaining health insurance coverage through the ACA marketplace. The executive order also instructed certain governmental
agencies to review and reconsider their existing policies and rules that limit access to healthcare, including among others, reexamining Medicaid
demonstration projects and waiver programs that include work requirements, and policies that create unnecessary barriers to obtaining access to health
insurance coverage through Medicaid or the ACA.
In addition, other legislative changes have been proposed and adopted since the Affordable Care Act was enacted. For example, the Budget
Control Act of 2011, among other things, included reductions to Medicare payments to providers, which went into effect on April 1, 2013 and, due to
subsequent legislative amendments to the statute, will remain in effect into 2032, with the exception of a temporary suspension from May 1, 2020 through
March 31, 2022, unless additional Congressional action is taken. Additionally, the American Taxpayer Relief Act of 2012, among other things, reduced
Medicare payments to several providers, including hospitals, and increased the statute of limitations period for the government to recover overpayments
to providers from three to five years. In addition, the Medicare Access and CHIP Reauthorization Act of 2015 enacted on April 16, 2015, repealed the
formula by which Medicare made annual payment adjustments to physicians and replaced the former formula with fixed annual updates and a new
system of incentive payments began in 2019 that are based on various performance measures and physicians’ participation in alternative payment models
such as accountable care organizations.
We expect additional state, federal, and foreign healthcare reform measures to be adopted in the future, any of which could limit the amounts
that federal, state, and foreign governments will pay for healthcare products and services, which could result in reduced demand for our future products or
additional pricing pressure.
If we fail to comply with our reporting and payment obligations under the Medicaid program or other governmental pricing programs, we could
be subject to additional reimbursement requirements, penalties, sanctions and fines which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial
condition, results of operations and growth prospects.
Pricing and rebate calculations vary among products and programs. The calculations are complex and will often be subject to interpretation by
us, governmental or regulatory agencies and the courts. If we become aware that our reporting of pricing data for a prior quarter was incorrect, we will be
obligated to resubmit the corrected data. For the Medicaid drug rebate program, corrected data must be submitted for a period not to exceed twelve
quarters from the quarter in which the data originally were due. Such restatements and recalculations increase our costs for complying with the laws and
regulations governing the Medicaid drug rebate program and other governmental pricing programs.
We may be liable for errors associated with our submission of pricing data. If we are found to have knowingly submitted false pricing data to the
Medicaid program, we may be liable for civil monetary penalties in the amount of up to U.S.$100,000 per item of false information. Our failure to submit
pricing data to the Medicaid program on a timely basis could result in a civil monetary penalty of U.S.$10,000 per day for each day the information is
late. Such failure also could be grounds to terminate our Medicaid drug rebate agreement, which is the agreement under which we might participate in the
Medicaid drug rebate program. In the event that our rebate agreement is terminated, federal payments may not be available under Medicaid for our
covered outpatient drugs. We cannot assure you that our submissions will not be found to be incomplete or incorrect.
If we obtain FDA approval for any of our product candidates and begin commercializing those products in the United States, our operations may
be directly or indirectly through our customers, subject to various federal and state fraud and abuse laws, including, without limitation, the federal Anti-
Kickback Statute, the federal False Claims Act, and physician sunshine laws and regulations.
15
The Biden administration also introduced various measures in 2021 focusing on healthcare and drug pricing, in particular. For example, on
January 28, 2021, President Biden issued an executive order that initiated a special enrollment period for purposes of obtaining health insurance coverage
through the ACA marketplace, which began on February 15, 2021, and remained open through August 15, 2021. The executive order also instructed
certain governmental agencies to review and reconsider their existing policies and rules that limit access to healthcare, including among others,
reexamining Medicaid demonstration projects and waiver programs that include work requirements and policies that create unnecessary barriers to
obtaining access to health insurance coverage through Medicaid or the ACA. On the legislative front, the American Rescue Plan Act of 2021 was signed
into law on March 11, 2021, which, in relevant part, eliminates the statutory Medicaid drug rebate cap, currently set at 100% of a drug’s average
manufacturer price, for single source drugs and innovator multiple source drugs, beginning January 1, 2024. And, in July 2021, the Biden administration
released an executive order entitled, “Promoting Competition in the American Economy,” with multiple provisions aimed at prescription drugs. In
response, on September 9, 2021, HHS released a “Comprehensive Plan for Addressing High Drug Prices” that outlines principles for drug pricing reform
and sets out a variety of potential legislative policies that Congress could pursue as well as potential administrative actions HHS can take to advance these
principles. And, in November 2021, President Biden announced the “Prescription Drug Pricing Plan” as part of the Build Back Better Act (H.R. 5376)
passed by the House of Representatives on November 19, 2021, which aims to lower prescription drug pricing by, among other things, allowing Medicare
to negotiate prices for certain high-cost prescription drugs covered under Medicare Part D and Part B after the drugs have been on the market for a certain
number of years and imposing tax penalties on drug manufacturers that refuse to negotiate pricing with Medicare or increase drug prices “faster than
inflation.” If enacted, this bill could have a substantial impact on our business. In the coming years, additional legislative and regulatory changes could be
made to governmental health programs that could significantly impact pharmaceutical companies and the success of our product candidates. At the state
level, legislatures have increasingly passed legislation and implemented regulations designed to control pharmaceutical and biological product pricing,
including price or patient reimbursement constraints, discounts, restrictions on certain product access and marketing cost disclosure and transparency
measures, and, in some cases, designed to encourage importation from other countries and bulk purchasing. There is uncertainty as to what healthcare
programs and regulations may be implemented or changed at the federal and/or state level in the United States or the effect of any future legislation or
regulation. Furthermore, we cannot predict what actions the Biden administration will implement in connection with the Health Reform Law. However, it
is possible that such initiatives could have an adverse effect on our ability to obtain approval and/or successfully commercialize products in the United
States in the future. For example, any changes that reduce, or impede the ability to obtain, reimbursement for our product candidates approved for
commercialization in the United States, if any, or any other drug products we may commercialize in the future or that reduce medical procedure volumes
could adversely affect our operations and/or future business plans.
In addition, the Inflation Reduction Act (IRA) of 2022 was signed into law in August 2022. This law, which, among other things, permits
Medicare to negotiate the price of certain high expenditure, single source drugs and biological drugs. The maximum fair prices that are negotiated for
these drugs will apply beginning with initial price applicability in 2026. The number of drugs to be selected and negotiated will depend on whether the
drugs are high in expenditures and will be limited each year in the number of drugs subject to a preset negotiation structure. Following a phased
implementation, ultimately there will be 20 drugs that will be subject to price negotiation by 2029 and thereafter. This legislative change will likely result
in reductions in Medicare payments and other health care expenditures that may impact the product candidates in the future. Any reimbursement policies
instituted by Medicare or other federal health care programs may result in similar policies from private payors.
The pharmaceutical and biotechnology industries are subject to extensive regulation, and from time to time legislative bodies and governmental
agencies consider changes to such regulations that could have significant impact on industry participants. For example, in light of certain highly-
publicised safety issues regarding certain drugs that had received marketing approval, the U.S. Congress has considered various proposals regarding drug
safety, including some which would require additional safety studies and monitoring and could make drug development more costly. The implementation
of cost containment measures or other healthcare system reforms may prevent us from being able to generate revenue, attain profitability, or
commercialise our products. Such reforms could have an adverse effect on anticipated revenues from product candidates that impact we may successfully
develop and for which we may obtain regulatory approval and may affect our overall financial condition and ability to develop product candidates. In
addition, it is possible that there will be further legislation or regulation that could harm our business, financial condition and several results of operations.
16
We could be adversely affected by violations of the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act.
Our business operations may be subject to anti-corruption laws and regulations, including restrictions imposed by the U.S. Foreign Corrupt
Practices Act (the “FCPA”). The FCPA and similar anti-corruption laws in other jurisdictions such as the U.K. Bribery Act generally prohibit companies
and their intermediaries from making improper payments to government officials for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. We cannot provide
assurance that our internal controls and procedures will always protect us from criminal acts committed by our employees or third parties with whom we
work. If we are found to be liable for violations of the FCPA or similar anti-corruption laws in international jurisdictions, either due to our own acts or
out of inadvertence, or due to the acts or inadvertence of others, we could suffer from criminal or civil penalties which could have a material and adverse
effect on our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
Risks Related to Intellectual Property
Our success depends upon our ability to protect our intellectual property and our proprietary technology, to operate without infringing
the proprietary rights of third parties and to obtain marketing exclusivity for our products and technologies.
Any future success will depend in large part on whether we can:
●
obtain and maintain patents to protect our own product candidates and technologies;
●
obtain licenses to the patented technologies of third parties;
●
operate without infringing on the proprietary rights of third parties; and
●
protect our trade secrets, know-how and other confidential information.
Patent matters in biotechnology are highly uncertain and involve complex legal and factual questions. Accordingly, the availability and breadth
of claims allowed in biotechnology and pharmaceutical patents cannot be predicted. Any of the pending or future patent applications filed by us or on our
behalf may not be approved, we may not develop additional proprietary products or processes that are patentable, or we may not be able to license any
other patentable products or processes.
Our products may be eligible for orphan designation for particular therapeutic indications that are of relatively low prevalence. Orphan drug
designation affords market exclusivity post marketing authorisation for a product for a specified therapeutic utility. The period of orphan protection is
dependent on jurisdiction, for example, seven years in the United States and ten years in Europe. The opportunity to gain orphan drug designation
depends on a variety of requirements specific to each marketing jurisdiction and can include; a showing of improved benefit relative to marketed
products, that the mechanism of action of the product would provide plausible benefit and the nature of the unmet medical need within a therapeutic
indication. It is uncertain if our products will be able to obtain orphan drug designation for the appropriate indications and in the jurisdictions sought.
There is a risk that the U.S. Congress, for example, could amend laws to significantly shorten the exclusivity period. Once any regulatory period
of exclusivity expires, depending on the status of our patent coverage and the nature of the product, we may not be able to prevent others from marketing
products that are similar to or interchangeable with our products, which would materially adversely affect us.
Our commercial success will also depend, in part, on our ability to avoid infringement of patents issued to others. If a court determines that we
were infringing any third-party patents, we could be required to pay damages, alter our products or processes, obtain licenses or cease certain activities.
Licenses required under patents held by third parties may not be made available on terms acceptable to us or at all. To the extent that we are unable to
obtain such licenses, we could be foreclosed from the development, export, manufacture or commercialisation of the product requiring such license or
encounter delays in product introductions while we attempt to design around such patents, and any of these circumstances could adversely affect our
business, financial condition and results of operations.
17
We may have to resort to litigation to enforce any patents issued or licensed to us or to determine the scope and validity of third-party
proprietary rights. We may have to defend the validity of our patents in order to protect or enforce our rights against a third party. Third parties may in the
future assert against us infringement claims or claims that we have infringed a patent, copyright, trademark or other proprietary right belonging to them.
Any infringement claim, even if not meritorious, could result in the expenditure of significant financial and managerial resources and could negatively
affect our profitability. While defending our patents, the scope of the claim may be reduced in breadth and inventorship of the claimed subject matter, and
proprietary interests in the claimed subject matter may be altered or reduced. Some of our competitors may be able to sustain the costs of such litigation
or proceedings more effectively than we can because of their substantially greater financial resources. Any such litigation, regardless of outcome, could
be expensive and time consuming, and adverse determinations in any such proceedings could prevent us from developing, manufacturing or
commercialising our products and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
The patents for our product candidates have varying expiration dates and, if these patents expire, we may be subject to increased competition and
we may not be able to recover our development costs or market any of our approved products profitably. In some of the larger potential market territories,
such as the United States and Europe, patent term extension or restoration may be available to compensate for time taken during aspects of the product’s
development and regulatory review or by procedural delays before the relevant patent office. However, such an extension may not be granted, or if
granted, the applicable time period or the scope of patent protection afforded during any extension period may not be sufficient. In addition, even though
some regulatory authorities may provide some other exclusivity for a product under their own laws and regulations, we may not be able to qualify the
product or obtain the exclusive time period. If we are unable to obtain patent term extension/restoration or some other exclusivity, we could be subject to
increased competition and our opportunity to establish or maintain product revenue could be substantially reduced or eliminated. Furthermore, we may
not have sufficient time to recover our development costs prior to the expiration of our U.S. and non-U.S. patents.
We may face difficulties in certain jurisdictions in protecting our intellectual property rights, which may diminish the value of our
intellectual property rights in those jurisdictions.
The laws of some jurisdictions do not protect intellectual property rights to the same extent as the laws in the United States and the European
Union, and many companies have encountered significant difficulties in protecting and defending such rights in such jurisdictions. If we or our
collaboration partners encounter difficulties in protecting, or are otherwise precluded from effectively protecting, the intellectual property rights
important for our business in such jurisdictions, the value of these rights may be diminished and we may face additional competition from others in those
jurisdictions.
Many countries have compulsory licensing laws under which a patent owner may be compelled to grant licenses to third parties. In addition,
many countries limit the enforceability of patents against government agencies or government contractors. In these countries, the patent owner may have
limited remedies, which could materially diminish the value of such patent. If we or any of our licensors is forced to grant a license to third parties with
respect to any patents relevant to our business, our competitive position may be impaired and our business, financial condition and results of operations
may be adversely affected.
Intellectual property rights do not address all potential threats to our competitive advantage.
The degree of future protection afforded by our intellectual property rights is uncertain because intellectual property rights have limitations, and
may not adequately permit us to maintain our competitive advantage. The following examples are illustrative:
●
Others may be able to make products that are similar to ours but that are not covered by the claims of the patents that we own.
●
Others may independently develop similar or alternative technologies or otherwise circumvent any of our technologies without infringing
our intellectual property rights.
●
We or any of our collaboration partners might not have been the first to conceive and reduce to practice the inventions covered by the
patents or patent applications that we own, license or will own or license.
18
●
We or any of our collaboration partners might not have been the first to file patent applications covering certain of the patents or patent
applications that we or they own or have obtained a license, or will own or will have obtained a license.
●
It is possible that our pending patent applications will not result in issued patents.
●
Issued patents that we own may not provide us with any competitive advantage, or may be held invalid or unenforceable, as a result of legal
challenges by our competitors.
●
Our competitors might conduct research and development activities in countries where we do not have patent rights, or in countries where
research and development safe harbor laws exist, and then use the information learned from such activities to develop competitive products
for sale in our major commercial markets.
●
The patents of third parties or pending or future applications of third parties, if issued, may have an adverse effect on our business.
●
Compulsory licensing provisions of certain governments to patented technologies that are deemed necessary for the government to access.
Changes in patent laws or patent jurisprudence could diminish the value of our patents, thereby impairing our ability to protect our
products or product candidates.
As is the case with other biotechnology and pharmaceutical companies, our success is heavily dependent on intellectual property, particularly
patents. Obtaining and enforcing patents in the pharmaceutical industry involves both technological and legal complexity, it is costly, time-consuming
and inherently uncertain. The U.S. Supreme Court has ruled on several patent cases in recent years, either narrowing the scope of patent protection
available in certain circumstances or weakening the rights of patent owners in certain situations. Depending on decisions by the U.S. Congress, the
federal courts, and the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office, or USPTO, the laws and regulations governing patents could change in unpredictable ways that
could weaken our ability to obtain new patents or to enforce our existing patents and patents that we might obtain in the future. Similarly, the complexity
and uncertainty of European patent laws has also increased in recent years. In addition, the European patent system is relatively stringent with regard to
the type of amendments that are allowed during prosecution. These changes could limit our ability to obtain new patents in the future that may be
important for our business.
Confidentiality agreements with employees and others may not adequately prevent disclosure of our trade secrets and protect our other
proprietary information.
We consider proprietary trade secrets and/or confidential know-how and unpatented know-how to be important to our business. We may rely on
trade secrets and/or confidential know-how to protect our technology, especially where patent protection is believed by us to be of limited value.
However, trade secrets and/or confidential know-how can be difficult to maintain as confidential.
To protect this type of information against disclosure or appropriation by competitors, our policy is to require our employees, consultants,
contractors and advisors to enter into confidentiality agreements with us. However, current or former employees, consultants, contractors and advisers
may unintentionally or willfully disclose our confidential information to competitors, and confidentiality agreements may not provide an adequate
remedy in the event of unauthorized disclosure of confidential information. Enforcing a claim that a third-party obtained illegally and is using trade
secrets and/or confidential know-how is expensive, time consuming and unpredictable. The enforceability of confidentiality agreements may vary from
jurisdiction to jurisdiction.
Failure to obtain or maintain trade secrets and/or confidential know-how trade protection could adversely affect our competitive position.
Moreover, our competitors may independently develop substantially equivalent proprietary information and may even apply for patent protection in
respect of the same. If successful in obtaining such patent protection, our competitors could limit our use of our trade secrets and/or confidential know-
how.
19
Risks Related to Our Compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
We may fail to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting in accordance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of
2002, which could adversely affect our operating results, investor confidence in our reported financial information, and the market price of our
ordinary shares and ADSs.
The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 imposes certain duties on us and our executives and directors. To comply with this statute, we are required to
document and test our internal control over financial reporting. Our efforts to comply with the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of
2002, governing internal control and procedures for financial reporting, have resulted in increased general and administrative expenses and a diversion of
management time and attention, and we expect these efforts to require the continued commitment of significant resources. We may identify material
weaknesses or significant deficiencies in our assessments of our internal control over financial reporting. Failure to maintain effective internal control
over financial reporting , or conclusion that our disclosure controls and procedures are ineffective, could result in investigations or sanctions by
regulatory authorities and could adversely affect our operating results, investor confidence in our reported financial information, and the market price of
our ordinary shares and ADSs.
Risks Related to Ownership of Our Securities
Our stock price may be volatile and the trading market for our securities is limited.
The market price for our securities, like that of the securities of other pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies, has fluctuated substantially
and may continue to be highly volatile in the future. The market price for our securities has been affected by both broad market developments and
announcements relating to actual or potential developments concerning products under development. We believe that the following factors, in addition to
other risk factors described above and elsewhere in this annual report, will continue to significantly affect the market price of our ordinary shares:
●
the results of pre-clinical testing and clinical trials by us and our competitors;
●
developments concerning research and development, manufacturing, and marketing alliances or collaborations by us and our competitors;
●
announcements of technological innovations or new commercial products by us and our competitors;
●
determinations regarding our patent applications, patents and those of others;
●
publicity regarding actual or potential results relating to medicinal products under development by us and our competitors;
●
proposed governmental regulations and developments in Australia, the U.S. and elsewhere;
●
litigation;
●
economic and other external factors; and
●
period-to-period fluctuations in our operating results.
In addition, stock markets have experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations. These fluctuations have especially affected the stock market
price of many high technology and healthcare related companies, including pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies, and, in many cases, are
unrelated to the operating performance of the particular companies. Market fluctuations, as well as general political and economic conditions, such as a
recession, interest rate or currency rate fluctuations, could adversely affect the market price of our securities.
Ownership interest in our company may be further diluted as a result of additional financings.
Potential dilution as a result of additional financings.
Ownership interest in our company may be diluted as a result of financings in the near future or over the longer term. We will need additional
funding to complete our clinical trials and to operate our business; such funding may not be available or, if it is available, such financing is likely to
substantially dilute our existing shareholders. Additional financing will comply with the relevant requirements of ASX listing rules and NASDAQ listing
requirements.
20
Without shareholder approval, we may not issue more than 25% of our outstanding ordinary shares in any twelve month period other than by a
pro rata rights offering or a share purchase plan offer (of shares with a value at the issue price of up to A$30,000 per shareholder to a maximum of 30%
of our outstanding shares) in each case to the then existing shareholders in accordance with the listing rules of the ASX. Sales of our ADSs offered
through our “At-The-Market” facility and future equity offerings may result in substantial dilution to the interests of our current shareholders. The sale of
a substantial number of securities to investors, or anticipation of such sales, could make it more difficult for us to sell equity or equity-related securities in
the future at a time and at a price that we might otherwise wish to effect sales.
There is a substantial risk that we are a passive foreign investment company, or PFIC, to some U.S. investors which will subject those
investors to adverse tax rules
Holders of our ADSs who are U.S. residents face income tax risks. There is a substantial risk that we are a passive foreign investment company,
commonly referred to as a PFIC to some U.S. investors, and a controlled foreign corporation, or CFC to other U.S. investors. Our treatment as a PFIC
could result in a reduction in the after-tax return to the holders of our ADSs and would likely cause a reduction in the value of such ADSs. For U.S.
federal income tax purposes, we will be classified as a PFIC for any taxable year in which either (i) 75% or more of our gross income is passive income,
or (ii) at least 50% of the average value of all of our assets for the taxable year produce or are held for the production of passive income. For this purpose,
cash is considered to be an asset that produces passive income. As a result of our substantial cash position and the decline in the value of our stock, we
believe that we became a PFIC during the taxable year ended June 30, 2005, and were classified as a PFIC during each of the following fiscal years. We
believe that we once again will be classified as a PFIC for the taxable year ended June 30, 2023 for some U.S. investors. Highly complex rules will apply
to U.S. holders owning ADSs. Accordingly, you are urged to consult your tax advisors regarding the application of such rules.
We do not anticipate paying dividends on our ordinary shares.
We have never declared or paid cash dividends on our ordinary shares and do not expect to do so in the foreseeable future. The declaration of
dividends is subject to the discretion of our Board of Directors and will depend on various factors, including our operating results, financial condition,
future prospects and any other factors deemed relevant by our board of directors. You should not rely on an investment in our company if you require
dividend income from your investment in our company. The success of your investment will likely depend entirely upon any future appreciation of the
market price of our ordinary shares, which is uncertain and unpredictable. There is no guarantee that our ordinary shares will appreciate in value or even
maintain the price at which you purchased your ordinary shares.
Currency fluctuations may adversely affect the price of our securities.
Our ordinary shares are quoted in Australian dollars on the ASX and our ADSs trade on the NASDAQ Capital Market in U.S. dollars.
Movements in the Australian dollar/U.S. dollar exchange rate may adversely affect the U.S. dollar price of our ordinary shares. In the past year the
Australian dollar strengthened against the U.S. dollar. If the Australian dollar weakens against the U.S. dollar, this may negatively affect the U.S. dollar
price of our ordinary shares, even if the price of our ordinary shares in Australian dollars decreases or remains unchanged. If the Australian dollar further
strengthens against the U.S. dollar, the U.S. dollar price of the ordinary shares could increase, even if the price of our ordinary shares in Australian dollars
decreases or remains unchanged.
If we fail to maintain compliance with NASDAQ’s continued listing requirements, our shares may be delisted from the NASDAQ
Capital Market.
Our ordinary shares are quoted on the ASX and our ADSs trade on the NASDAQ Capital Market. To continue to be listed on the NASDAQ
Capital Market, we need to satisfy a number of conditions, including a minimum closing bid price per ADS of $1.00 for 30 consecutive business days and
shareholders’ equity of at least $2.5 million.
We could in the future fail to meet this or other NASDAQ continued listing requirements and fail to cure such noncompliance, resulting in the
delisting of our ADSs from NASDAQ. If we are delisted from NASDAQ, trading in our ordinary shares could be conducted on a U.S. market where an
investor would likely find it significantly more difficult to dispose of, or to obtain accurate quotations as to the value of, our ordinary shares (such
delisting should not affect the trading over the ASX).
21
We are currently operating in a period of economic uncertainty and capital markets disruption, which has been significantly impacted
by geopolitical instability due to the ongoing military conflicts such as in the Middle East and between Russia and Ukraine.
U.S. and global markets are experiencing volatility and disruption following the escalation of geopolitical tensions and the start of military
conflicts in the Middle East and the ongoing conflict between Russia and Ukraine.
In February 2022, Russia launched a full-scale military invasion of Ukraine. Although the length and impact of the ongoing military conflict is
highly unpredictable, the conflict in Ukraine could lead to market disruptions, including significant volatility in commodity prices, credit and capital
markets. Additionally, Russia’s prior annexation of Crimea, recent recognition of two separatist republics in the Donetsk and Luhansk regions of Ukraine
and subsequent military interventions in Ukraine have led to sanctions and other penalties being levied by the United States, European Union and other
countries against Russia, including agreement to remove certain Russian financial institutions from the Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial
Telecommunication (SWIFT) payment system. Additional potential sanctions and penalties have also been proposed and/or threatened. Russian military
actions and the resulting sanctions could adversely affect the global economy and financial markets and lead to instability and lack of liquidity in capital
markets, potentially making it more difficult for us to obtain additional funds. Any of the abovementioned factors could affect our business, prospects,
financial condition, and operating results. The extent and duration of the military action, sanctions and resulting market disruptions are impossible to
predict, but could be substantial.
In addition, economic and political instability in other regions, e.g., the Israel-Hamas conflict and the related instability in the Middle East, may
result in unavoidable uncertainties that could negatively affect costs of business and cause volatility in exchange rates, commodity prices, inflation and
interest rates. Such events could also impact worldwide political, regulatory, economic or market conditions, as well as causing instability in political
institutions, regulatory agencies and financial markets, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, cash flows
and financial position.
Any such disruptions may also magnify the impact of other risks described in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.
Risks Related to Our Location in Australia
It may be difficult to enforce a judgment in the United States against us and our officers and directors or to assert U.S. securities laws
claims in Australia or serve process on our officers and directors.
We are incorporated in Australia. More than half of our executive officers and directors are non-residents of the United States. Therefore, it may
be difficult for an investor, or any other person or entity, to enforce a U.S. court judgment based upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal
securities laws in an Australian court against us or any of those persons or to effect service of process upon these persons in the United States.
Additionally, it may be difficult for an investor, or any other person or entity, to enforce civil liabilities under U.S. federal securities laws in original
actions instituted in Australia.
As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed on The NASDAQ Capital Market, we may follow certain home country corporate
governance practices instead of certain NASDAQ requirements.
As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed on the NASDAQ Capital Market, we are permitted to follow certain home country corporate
governance practices instead of certain requirements of The NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. Among other things, as a foreign private issuer we may
follow home country practice with regard to the composition of the board of directors, director nomination procedure, and quorum at shareholders’
meetings. In addition, we may follow our home country law, instead of the NASDAQ Stock Market Rules, which require that we obtain shareholder
approval for certain dilutive events such as for the establishment or amendment of certain equity based compensation plans, an issuance that will result in
a change of control of the company, certain transactions other than a public offering involving issuances of a 20% or more interest in the company, and
certain acquisitions of the stock or assets of another company. A foreign private issuer that elects to follow a home country practice instead of NASDAQ
requirements must submit to NASDAQ in advance a written statement from an independent counsel in such issuer’s home country certifying that the
issuer’s practices are not prohibited by the home country’s laws. In addition, a foreign private issuer must disclose in its annual reports filed with the SEC
each such requirement that it does not follow and describe the home country practice followed by the issuer instead of any such requirement.
Accordingly, our shareholders may not be afforded the same protection as provided under NASDAQ’s corporate governance rules.
22
We currently do not have a majority of independent directors serving on our Board of Directors, which may afford less protection to
our shareholders than if our Board of Directors had a majority of independent directors.
As of the date of this annual report, a majority of our directors did not satisfy the standards for independence as specified by the SEC and the
listing standards of The Nasdaq Stock Market pursuant to which we evaluate director independence. If our Board of Directors is not made up of a
majority of independent directors, there may be a lower level of oversight on executive management, and our Board of Directors may be influenced by
the concerns, issues or objectives of management, including compensation and governance issues, to a greater extent than would occur with a majority of
independent directors. As a result, the composition of our Board of Directors may afford less protection to our shareholders than if our Board of Directors
were composed of a majority of independent directors.
A lack of independent directors may also make it difficult to create board committees meeting the requirements of our board committee charters
and the NASDAQ Rules pursuant to which we evaluate director independence. Historically, we have strived to have an audit committee comprised of at
least three independent directors and other board committees comprised solely of independent directors. Currently, our audit committee has only two
members, both of who are independent under the NASDAQ Rules and applicable SEC requirements. Due to the lack of independent directors, it may be
difficult to establish effective operating board committees comprised of independent members to oversee committee functions. This structure gives our
executive officers additional control over certain corporate governance issues, including compensation matters and audit issues for internal control and
reporting purposes, with more limited oversight of our executive officers’ decisions and activities.
Australian takeovers laws may discourage takeover offers being made for us or may discourage the acquisition of large numbers of our
ordinary shares.
We are incorporated in Australia and are subject to the takeover’s laws of Australia. Among other things, we are subject to the Australian
Corporations Act 2001, or the Corporations Act. Subject to a range of exceptions, the Corporations Act prohibits the acquisition of a direct or indirect
interest in our issued voting shares if the acquisition of that interest will lead to a person’s voting power in us increasing from 20% or below to more than
20%, or increasing from a starting point that is above 20% and below 90%. Australian takeovers laws may discourage takeover offers being made for us
or may discourage the acquisition of large numbers of our ordinary shares. This may have the ancillary effect of entrenching our board of directors and
may deprive or limit our shareholders’ strategic opportunities to sell their ordinary shares and may restrict the ability of our shareholders to obtain a
premium from such transactions.
Our Constitution and other Australian laws and regulations applicable to us may adversely affect our ability to take actions that could
be beneficial to our shareholders.
As an Australian company we are subject to different corporate requirements than a corporation organized under the laws of the United States.
Our Constitution, as well as the Corporations Act, set forth various rights and obligations that are unique to us as an Australian company. These
requirements operate differently than from many U.S. companies and may limit or otherwise adversely affect our ability to take actions that could be
beneficial to our shareholders. For more information, you should carefully review the summary of these matters set forth under the section entitled, “Item
10.B - Additional Information - Memorandum and Articles of Association” as well as our Constitution.
23
ITEM 4. INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY
A.
HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY
Our legal and commercial name is Alterity Therapeutics Limited (formerly Prana Biotechnology Limited). We were incorporated under the laws
of the Commonwealth of Australia on November 11, 1997 and began limited operations shortly thereafter. On April 8, 2019, we changed our name to
Alterity Therapeutics Limited. Our registered office is located at Level 3, 62 Lygon Street, Carlton, Victoria, 3053, Australia and our telephone number is
+-61-3-9824-5254. Our principal executive office is located at Level 14, 350 Collins Street, Melbourne, VIC 3000, Australia and our telephone number is
+-61-3-9349-4906. Our website address is www.alteritytherapeutics.com. The information in our website is not incorporated by reference into this annual
report.
Alterity’s mission from inception was to treat neurodegenerative diseases and its mission has remained focused on this class of diseases.
Alterity is developing first-in-class therapies to treat neurodegenerative diseases. Our lead drug candidate, ATH434, is designed to block the
accumulation and aggregation of α-synuclein, a protein implicated in neurodegeneration. ATH434 has been shown preclinically to reduce α-synuclein
pathology, preserve nerve cells, and improve motor function by restoring normal iron balance in the brain. In this way, it has potential to treat Parkinson’s
disease as well as Multiple System Atrophy (MSA), a rare Parkinsonian disorder. The company has been granted Orphan drug designation for ATH434
for the treatment of MSA by both the US FDA and European Commission. The exclusivity conferred by the Orphan drug designation is expected to
persist beyond the term of the patents comprising the ATH434 global patent portfolio.
Phase 1 enabling studies have been completed and we have commenced a randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled Phase 2 clinical trial
with recruitment of patients underway. The global trial has received regulatory authorization to proceed in Australia,New Zealand, the United States of
America,Italy, and the UK.
Our technology is the outcome of many years of intense research from leading scientists in neurodegenerative disorders and other diseases.
Beginning with the discovery and patenting of our initial clinical drug candidate, PBT2, the company continued to apply its expertise to inventing and
patenting novel molecules with potential to treat neurodegenerative diseases which resulted in ATH434 (see above).
In 2019 and 2020, we invented next generation iron chaperones, a technology capable of redistributing excess iron in the central nervous system
including for the treatment of Alzheimer’s disease and Parkinson’s disease. These compounds are the subject of composition of matter claims in patent
families which either are filed in countries and regions that represent the commercially significant economies or are earmarked to be filed in those
countries.
In 2021, we invented next generation zinc ionophores, a technology capable of modulating zinc for the treatment of various diseases such as
cancer, neurological diseases and infectious diseases. These compounds are the subject of composition of matter claims in a patent family which is
earmarked for filing in countries and regions that represent the commercially significant economies.
Our technology has progressed to create a diversified library of chemical compounds and we continue to strengthen our intellectual property
portfolio with new patents generated by our discovery and research efforts. This may yield future product candidates across various neurodegenerative
and other indications.
Since inception, we have not been required to invest material amounts for capital expenditures since our development efforts have taken place at
research facilities operated by institutions with which we have relationships. In the three fiscal years ended June 30, 2024, our capital expenditures have
totalled A$102,180.
24
B.
BUSINESS OVERVIEW
Alterity’s Background
Our technology has been developed over an extended period and continues to develop through the collaborative efforts of highly regarded
scientists, company employees as well as representatives of research institutions in this field.
Since completing our initial public offering and listing process of our ordinary shares on the ASX on March 28, 2000, we historically
concentrated our resources toward the pursuit of neurological diseases with an initial focus in Alzheimer’s disease, and creation of a chemical library of
proprietary molecules. Currently, our research and clinical development efforts are primarily focused on Parkinson’s disease and related disorders where
we are identifying and developing novel compounds that address the underlying pathology of these disorders by binding and redistributing excess iron,
reducing alpha-synuclein (or α -synuclein) aggregation, and rescuing neurons in the brain.
Our clinical development program is led by two Phase 2 clinical trials in Multiple System Atrophy, or MSA, a rare parkinsonian disorder with
no approved treatments that address the underlying pathology of the disease. We are also conducting a Natural History Study in MSA and have a
preclinical program in Parkinson’s disease.
We also have a robust discovery platform with over 1000 validated compounds from different chemical scaffolds in our chemical library.
Since 2009, our chemistry program is undertaken within laboratories leased from The University of Melbourne’s Bio21 Molecular Science and
Biotechnology Institute, which is a multidisciplinary research center that specializes in medical, agricultural and environmental biotechnology.
Accommodating more than 800 research scientists, students and industry participants, the Bio21 Institute is one of the largest biotechnology research
centers in Australia.
Candidate product discovery and translational Biology Programs
Alterity’s intellectual property is considered “platform technology” based on our approach that a broad spectrum of neurodegenerative and age-
related diseases can be addressed by targeting the interrelationship of metals and proteins. Historically, the majority of our research efforts have been
directed at research into potential therapeutics for the treatment of Alzheimer’s disease, Huntington disease and Parkinsonian disorders. Published data
together with our initial findings have provided strong indications that the pathology for other certain age-related and degenerative disorders may also be
based on the interaction between certain metals and proteins, and we believe that the platform technology may also be applicable for certain cancers, age-
related macular degeneration, diabetes mellitus, cardiovascular disease and other neurodegenerative diseases.
To date, we have performed in vivo evaluations of our product candidates in a range of animal models of disease including parkinsonian
disorders, Alzheimer’s disease, Huntington disease, and brain cancer.
Product candidates are selected from our chemical library on the basis of rational drug design. Product candidates are designed to fulfil very
specific criteria such as oral bioavailability and ability to cross the blood-brain barrier, and demonstrate significant effectiveness in both nonclinical in
vitro and in vivo testing.
To increase the depth and breadth of our pipeline into new neurodegenerative indications, we have continued to develop our ‘two tier’
Translational Research program structure. The first tier encompasses core new chemical entity design, synthesis and characterization, the ‘discovery
phase’ of the new entities as potential novel agents of interest based on their mechanism of action profile. Our discovery research has established
Structure Activity Relationships (“SAR”) within chemical moieties that guide our chemists towards the design of novel therapeutics. The discovery phase
also includes preliminary bioavailability and metabolic characterization. The second tier comprises ‘translational’ animal modeling programs to test and
validate new candidates as potential development product candidates.
Our chemical library currently includes more than 1000 novel compounds. Using SAR that has been developed over years of testing and
validation by Alterity scientists, new compounds are being generated that retain functionality across diverse and novel chemical scaffolds.
New compounds from various scaffolds are synthesised and mechanistically profiled. These compounds are initially screened for activity in
biological systems relevant to the candidate diseases of interest. New screens are investigated and assessed for their ability to intercede in the steps
thought to underly the pathogenesis of target diseases. Such steps include pathologic protein aggregation and downstream activities such as oxidative
stress and cell death. Promising candidates arising from the Translational Research program may be progressed as back up compounds in Parkinson’s
disease and/or new indications in neurodegeneration.
During the fiscal year, we continued to strengthen our intellectual property portfolio with new patents that will be instrumental in supporting
Alterity’s drug development portfolio. In August 2023, we announced the granting of a new Composition of Matter patent in Europe covering more than
150 novel compounds with pharmaceutical compositions that are designed to redistribute the excess iron implicated in neurodegenerative diseases. The
patent secures broad protection over a new class of iron chaperone drug candidates for treating major neurodegenerative diseases.
25
Our Target Neurodegenerative Diseases
Multiple System Atrophy
We believe that drug candidates in our library may affect the aggregation of the proteins implicated in the pathology of neurodegenerative
diseases including Parkinson’s disease and related movement disorders such as Multiple System Atrophy, or MSA.
We are focusing on the treatment of parkinsonian disorders, a group of neurodegenerative disorders which have parkinsonism as a feature.
Parkinsonism is a general term for slowed movement, stiffness and tremor, which occurs most commonly in idiopathic Parkinson’s disease and
less frequently in other parkinsonian disorders such as MSA and Progressive Supranuclear Palsy (PSP), among others. These parkinsonian disorders have
a limited response to available drugs for treating symptoms of Parkinson’s disease and prominent non-motor symptoms.
MSA is a rare, neurodegenerative disease characterized by failure of the autonomic nervous system and impaired movement. The symptoms
reflect the progressive loss of function and death of different types of neurons and support cells in the brain and spinal cord. It is a rapidly progressive
disease which causes profound disability. It is sporadic (not inherited) and typically presents in individuals between 50 and 60 years old. MSA is
characterized by a variable combination of parkinsonism, autonomic instability that affects involuntary functions such as blood pressure maintenance and
bowel/bladder control, and impaired balance and/or coordination that predisposes to falls. A pathological hallmark of MSA is the accumulation of the
protein α-synuclein within glia, the support cells of the central nervous system, and neuron loss in multiple brain regions. According to the U.S. National
Institutes of Health, MSA affects up to 50,000 individuals in the U.S., thus it is considered an Orphan Disease. While some of the symptoms of MSA can
be treated with medications, currently there are no drugs that are able to slow disease progression and there is no cure.
Because early MSA is not well characterized, Alterity has been conducting a natural history study called “Biomarkers of progression in Multiple
System Atrophy (bioMUSE)” to track the progression of patients with MSA. The study is being conducted in collaboration with Vanderbilt University
Medical Center in the U.S. under the direction of Daniel Claassen, MD, Professor of Neurology and Principal Investigator. Natural history studies are
important for characterizing disease progression in selected patient populations. The study is ongoing and continues to provide vital information on early
stage MSA patients, enabling the selection of biomarkers suitable for evaluation of target engagement and preliminary efficacy of drug candidates, and
clinical data to characterize disease progression in patients that mirror those enrolling in Alterity’s ATH434-201 Phase 2 clinical trial. To date, the study
has provided rich data for optimizing the design of Alterity’s clinical program. (see below)
Alterity’s lead candidate, ATH434, is a small molecule drug candidate designed to inhibit the aggregation of pathological proteins implicated in
neurodegeneration. ATH434 has been shown preclinically to reduce α-synuclein pathology and preserve nerve cells by restoring normal iron balance in
the brain. In this way, it has excellent potential to treat Parkinson’s disease as well as parkinsonian disorders such as MSA.
A comprehensive nonclinical program to evaluate ATH434’s profile to support clinical development is ongoing. ATH434 has also been profiled
in mouse models of parkinsonian disorders, including MSA. In one animal model, ATH434 prevents α-synuclein aggregation and preserves neurons in
the substantia nigra and decreased the number of glial cell inclusions in the brains of treated animals. Glial cell inclusions are the pathological hallmark
of MSA and contain abundant aggregated α-synuclein that is associated with neurodegeneration. The pathologic benefits were associated with improved
motor function in treated animals.
In the nonclinical studies, ATH434 had no relevant off-target binding activity in a broad panel of protein interactions. ATH434 did not have
significant inhibitory activity of the hERG channel relevant to expected human plasma concentrations in a Good Laboratory Practices (GLP) study.
ATH434 is brain penetrant and is subject to diverse metabolic pathways.
ATH434 has successfully completed Phase 1 clinical studies demonstrating the agent is well tolerated, orally bioavailable, and achieved brain
levels comparable to efficacious levels in animal models of MSA. ATH434 is currently in two Phase 2 clinical trials (see below). ATH434 has been
granted Orphan designation for the treatment of MSA by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration, or FDA, and the European Commission.
26
Parkinson’s Disease
Parkinson’s disease, a neurodegenerative disease of the aging population, causes a progressive slowing of movement, tremors and the loss of
fine motor control due to the death of substantia nigra cells in the brain. These cells produce the neurotransmitter dopamine in the brain, which is
required for normal motor control. Existing therapies, such as dopaminergic agents, may provide symptomatic relief, but do not address the underlying
pathology of the disease.
In 2005, we entered into a contractual arrangement with the Integrative Neuroscience Facility based at the Florey Institute of Neuroscience and
Mental Health in Melbourne, (“Florey Institute”), to assist in the efficacy evaluation of novel compounds in models relevant to Parkinson’s disease,
specifically the 6-hydroxydopamine mouse model and the MPTP (1-methyl-4-phenyl-1,2,3,6-tetrahydropyridine) mouse model. The toxins used in these
two mouse models mimic the disease by causing impairment of the cells of the substantia nigra, the area of the brain primarily affected in Parkinson’s
disease, and subsequent loss of motor function.
During 2009 and 2010, our lead Parkinson’s disease treatment candidate emerged, ATH434 (described below and formerly known as PBT434),
based on significant improvement in motor function and coordination in both models. Importantly, ATH434 demonstrated improved relevant indices
when administered after toxins had destroyed significant amounts of substantia nigra nerve cells, indicating that the compound can preserve normal
neuronal function. Mechanistic work during this period demonstrated that ATH434 reduced the aggregation of toxic α-synuclein species as well as
markers of oxidative stress.
Since 2011, we have continually progressed our understanding of the mechanism of action of ATH434 and its potential to treat other movement
disorders characterized by the aggregation of α-synuclein. Our non-clinical research and development activities in Parkinson’s disease were supported by
a USD $206,000 grant from the New York-based Michael J. Fox Foundation entitled, ‘ATH434, a Novel Neuroprotective Drug For Parkinson’s Disease;
Completion of Pre-Clinical Studies to Enable Human Clinical Trials.’
In 2017, Doctors Finkelstein, Cherny and colleagues published data indicating that ATH434 prevented cell death in the substantia nigra in a
dose-dependent manner. The data also demonstrated the therapeutic potential of ATH434 to slow neurodegeneration with results in multiple Parkinson’s
disease models, including a transgenic model of Parkinson’s disease (A53T) in which mice over-expressed the α-synuclein protein. In A53T mice,
animals treated with ATH434 exhibited significantly increased numbers of s. nigra neurons and a significant reduction in insoluble α-synuclein and
incidence of clasping behavior. Encouragingly, these results showed that ATH434 lowered α-synuclein, preserved neurons and simultaneously improved
motor performance. The paper was entitled, “The novel compound ATH434 prevents iron mediated neurodegeneration and α -synuclein toxicity in
multiple models of Parkinson’s disease” and was published in Acta Neuropathol Comm.
In February 2021, the Michael J. Fox Foundation awarded Alterity a second grant, entitled “Pharmacologic Evaluation of ATH434 in a
Hemiparkinsonian Nonhuman Primate Model for Dose Optimization in PD Clinical Trials” in the amount of USD $495,000. The goal of the study was to
evaluate the pharmacologic profile of ATH434 for determining the optimal doses of ATH434 for future Parkinson’s disease clinical trials. The study was
completed in late 2023.
In December 2023, we announced that promising new data on the effect of ATH434 in a Parkinson’s disease primate model was presented at the
Future of Parkinson’s Disease Conference 2023. The poster, entitled, “Effects of ATH434, a Clinical-Phase Small Molecule with Moderate Affinity for
Iron, in Hemiparkinsonian Macaques”, was presented in collaboration from Vanderbilt University Medical Center and the Florey Institute of
Neuroscience in Melbourne. The presentation showed that ATH434 can reduce Parkinsonism in a higher order animal, the monkey, with symptoms that
closely parallel human disease. ATH434 treatment improved motor performance and general function in monkeys with experimentally induced
Parkinson’s disease. Importantly, these improvements were associated with reductions in abnormal iron in affected brain regions. These favorable
parkinsonian outcomes observed in the ATH434-treated monkeys were also associated with increased levels of striatal synaptophysin, a protein marker
that reflects functional connections between neurons, suggesting functional recovery of nerve endings in this critical motor pathway.
27
In September 2022, the peer-reviewed journal, Neurotherapeutics, published data that demonstrated ATH434 was neuroprotective in a genetic
model of Parkinson’s disease (PD). The publication, entitled “ATH434 Rescues Pre-motor Hyposmia in a Mouse Model of Parkinsonism” assessed the
impact of ATH434 on motor and non-motor deficits in mice with genetically induced PD. Hyposmia, defined as reduced sensitivity to odor, is an early
and common non-motor symptom of PD that precedes the typical motor symptoms by several years, occurring in approximately 90% of early-stage cases
of PD. The study found that ATH434 prevented a loss of smell in the younger mice and rescued it in older mice. More importantly, the authors also
demonstrated that ATH434 prevented the development of motor impairment in older animals, which was associated with a reduction in iron levels and
preservation of neurons in the substantia nigra, the brain region affected in Parkinson’s. These data support other studies indicating that ATH434 has a
beneficial effect on the motor and non-motor symptoms in animal models of PD.
In October 2021, The Journal of Parkinson’s Disease published the results from a preclinical study investigating the effect of ATH434 on
gastrointestinal complications titled “ATH434 Reverses Colorectal Dysfunction in the A53T Mouse Model of Parkinson’s Disease”. Non-motor
symptoms are common in patients with Parkinsonian disorders, such as Parkinson’s disease and MSA. Parkinson’s disease patients experience
gastrointestinal complications, cognitive deficits, autonomic dysfunction, and mood disturbance and these non-motor manifestations are an important
source of morbidity and reduced quality of life.
Alzheimer’s disease
PBT2 was our product candidate for Alzheimer’s disease. The drug candidate is orally bioavailable and has shown to cross the blood-brain
barrier.
Pre-clinical research findings for PBT2 have been published in high impact scientific journals. In 2008 we reported in the journal Neuron that
PBT2 could rapidly improve cognition in transgenic mice, prevent the formation of toxic soluble Abeta oligomers, lower the Abeta levels in the brain of
transgenic mice and protect neurons from the toxic effect of Abeta at the synapses between neurons. In 2010, we reported in The Journal of Neuroscience
on the loss of synaptic zinc uptake mechanisms in aged animal models and how this correlated with cognitive impairment. In March 2011, we reported in
the scientific journal PLoS ONE that PBT2 increased the numbers of spines on the branches (or dendrites) of neurons in the hippocampus, a memory
centre affected in Alzheimer’s disease, thereby increasing the number of spines permits many more neurons to interconnect with any particular neuron
thereby increasing the brain’s capacity to carry out learning and memory. These findings provided insight into how PBT2 has potential to preserve and
protect neurons in Alzheimer’s disease. It is believed that the zinc ionophore property of PBT2 works to increase intracellular zinc in the post synaptic
terminal, triggering the release of calcium which in turn, leads to neuroprotective pathways being activated inside the neuron that prevent excitotoxicity.
A 2013 paper, entitled “A Novel Approach to Rapidly Prevent Age-Related Cognitive Decline” was published in the journal Aging Cell and
demonstrated that PBT2 could restore the cognition of aged mice to that of young, cognitively intact mice. A 2015 paper, entitled “PBT2 inhibits
glutamate-induced excitotoxicity in neurons through metal-mediated preconditioning”, and published in Neurobiology of Disease demonstrated that
PBT2 protected against glutamate-induced excitotoxicity.
PBT2 was found to be well tolerated in Phase 1 and Phase 2 trials. Phase 1 trials were completed by February 2006 in healthy young and aged
volunteers and demonstrated that the drug was well tolerated and suitable for Phase 2 clinical development. In 2008, top line results for a Phase 2a
clinical study in mild Alzheimer’s disease patients supported PBT2’s safety and tolerability as well as its efficacy with respect to secondary cognition
endpoints.
In March 2014, we announced the top line results of the 12-month Phase 2 Imaging trial in Alzheimer’s Disease (“IMAGINE” Trial). PBT2 did
not meet its primary endpoint of a statistically significant reduction in the levels of beta-amyloid plaques in the brains of prodromal/mild Alzheimer’s
disease patients, as measured using PiB-PET Standardized Uptake Value Ratio (SUVR). Whilst there was a reduction in the overall levels of the PiB PET
signal in patients treated with PBT2, the results were confounded by an atypical reduction of levels of the PiB PET signal in the placebo group as well.
No improvement was observed on the secondary endpoints of brain metabolic activity, cognition and function; however, there was a trend towards
preserving hippocampal brain volume in the PBT2 group. PBT2 was shown to be safe and well tolerated over the 52 weeks. The adverse event profile
was equivalent between placebo and treated groups. Forty of the 42 enrolled participants (95%) completed the 52-week treatment period.
Participants were provided the option to continue treatment on PBT2 for a further 52 weeks in an open label study, the ‘IMAGINE Extension
study’ and 33 participants elected to do so with 27 participants completing the IMAGINE Extension study. The independent Data Safety Monitoring
Board did not identify any safety concerns related to PBT2 over the combined two-year period of the IMAGINE and IMAGINE Extension studies.
28
Unpublished analysis of the IMAGINE Extension data does not distinguish between 12 and 24 months of exposure to PBT2 on any of the
measured trial outcomes. However, exploratory post-hoc information from the Extension phase suggest that for the cohort of 27 trial participants that
completed all 24 months (11 of the 15 participants that started IMAGINE on placebo together with 16 of the 25 participants that remained on PBT2 for
24 months), the amyloid levels decreased in this cohort compared to an historical control group from the Australian Imaging Biomarker and Lifestyle
(AIBL) study.
In March 2023, we announced a sub-licensing agreement for PBT2 to Professor Colin Masters, M.D., A.O., to advance compounds for the
treatment of Alzheimer’s and related diseases. Under the license agreement, Alterity grants the entire rights to the acyl hydrazone patent mentioned
above, as well as an exclusive worldwide license to develop and commercialize both acyl hydrazone and PBT2 in Alzheimer’s disease. In exchange,
Alterity is entitled to future royalties of net sales from the assets.
Huntington disease
Huntington disease is a progressive, autosomal dominant neurodegenerative disorder of the central nervous system caused by a mutation in a
gene which encodes the huntingtin protein. The disease results in physical, cognitive and behavioral impairments that lead to severe incapacitation and
eventually death, generally 15-25 years after the onset of the disease. Huntington disease primarily affects adults, usually between the ages of 30 and 50.
US-based researchers presented the effects of clioquinol in an animal model of Huntington disease, showing evidence of improved behavior,
motor skills and inhibition of the abnormal form of the Huntingtin protein. Based on these findings, several proprietary compounds were tested in
collaboration with researchers based at the Veterans Affairs Medical Center and the Department of Neurology, University of California, San Francisco,
under a collaborative research agreement. PBT2 has demonstrated efficacy in the R6/2 mouse model of Huntington disease.
In July 2008, we received the findings from a report commissioned by us from US-based clinical researchers on the suitability of PBT2 for
Huntington disease. The report recommended that we proceed to clinical trials in Huntington disease research participants. In late 2012 we finalized the
enrolment to a Phase 2 trial to test PBT2 in patients with Huntington disease over six months. The trial, known as “Reach2HD”, was undertaken under an
U.S. IND application and was conducted in clinical sites across the United States and Australia. The primary objective of the study was achieved with
PBT2 being demonstrated as safe and well tolerated in this first study of PBT2 in Huntington disease.
In 2014, we announced that PBT2 had been granted Orphan Drug designation in the treatment of Huntington disease by the FDA. In June 2015,
the European Commission granted Orphan Drug designation for PBT2 for the treatment of Huntington disease.
During 2015 and 2016, three new PBT2 Phase 1 trials were completed. The data from these trials provided further safety, pharmacokinetic and
pharmacodynamic information on PBT2. Notwithstanding the clinical safety demonstrated to date with PBT2 in our Phase 2 programs in Alzheimer’s
disease and Huntington disease, in February 2015 we reported that the FDA had placed PBT2 on Partial Clinical Hold, based on toxicology findings.
These toxicology findings limited the dose of PBT2 that could be used in future trials.
29
Non-neurodegenerative applications
Antibiotic Resistance
In December 2020, Alterity acquired an exclusive world-wide license from UniQuest, the commercialisation company of The University of
Queensland (UQ), for the development and commercialization of novel zinc ionophore technology to combat antimicrobial resistance in superbugs.
Under the license, Alterity has the rights to develop and commercialise therapies that re-sensitize bacteria to antibiotics. The licensed technology
combines Alterity’s PBT2 and other zinc ionophores with commonly used antibiotics to treat infections caused by multidrug resistant bacteria. A
published article in the high-impact journal Science Translational Medicine, showed that PBT2 could reverse antibiotic resistance to critical superbugs
and demonstrate efficacy in an animal model of sepsis.
Clinical Trials for Our Product Candidates
Our Current Pipeline
ATH434
In July 2019 we announced the completion of a clinical trial evaluating the safety and pharmacokinetics of ATH434 in healthy volunteers. The
Phase 1 study, conducted in Australia, recruited 80 adult volunteers which included ten elderly people (over 65 years) with the key goals of assessing the
safety, tolerability and drug disposition within the body (pharmacokinetics) of ATH434 after single and multiple oral dose administration.
The volunteers in the single ascending dose phase of the study, made up of four individual dose levels in ascending order, received a single oral
dose of ATH434 and a blood sampling over the next 72 hours. In the multiple ascending dose phase of the study, volunteers received eight days dosing
with ATH434, administered as three successively higher dose levels, with intensive blood sampling for pharmacokinetics on days 1 and 8. At the two
highest multiple dose levels, cerebrospinal fluid was collected at steady state to determine drug penetration to the site of action in the brain. The older
adults (≥65 years) received the highest dose level for 8 days as well.
The study was successfully completed with systemic exposure to the drug comparable between adult and older adult volunteers. ATH434 was
found to be safe and well tolerated. Adverse event rates were found to be comparable with placebo and no subject experienced a serious adverse event or
an adverse event that led to discontinuation of the study drug.
The clinical data were presented at the American Academy of Neurology Annual Meeting in May 2019. The presentation was based on an
abstract entitled A phase 1 Study of ATH434, a Novel Small Molecule Inhibitor of α-synuclein Aggregation, in Adult and Older Adult Volunteers
published in the journal Neurology. In September 2019, we presented a poster titled: A First in Human Study of ATH434, a Novel Small Molecule
Inhibitor of α-Synuclein Aggregation at the 2019 International Congress of Parkinson’s Disease and Movement Disorders (MDS Congress) in Nice,
France. The poster presented findings from the completed Phase 1 trial based on an abstract published in the journal Movement Disorders.
Alterity applied to the FDA for Orphan Drug designation for the proposed use of ATH434 for the treatment of MSA, and the designation was
granted in January 2019. Orphan designation entitles Alterity to seven years of market exclusivity for the use of ATH434 in the treatment of MSA and
qualifies the sponsor of the drug for various development incentives of the Orphan Drug Act, including tax credits for qualified clinical testing.
In January 2020 it was announced that the European Commission, or EC, granted Orphan Drug designation to ATH434, which entitles Alterity
to ten years of market exclusivity in the European Union, or EU, for the use of ATH434 in the treatment of MSA and other benefits including assistance
in developing clinical protocols, reduced fees and access to EU-funded research grants.
30
ATH-434-201 Phase 2 Clinical Trial
In July 2022, we commenced our first Phase 2 clinical trial of ATH434 in patients with early-stage MSA. The trial, known as ATH434-201, is a
randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled investigation that is exploring the effect of ATH434 treatment on imaging and protein biomarkers
including excess iron which is an important contributor to MSA pathology. Clinical endpoints and activity data from wearable sensors will permit
comprehensive assessment of ATH434 efficacy along with characterization of safety and pharmacokinetics. The study was expected to enroll
approximately 60 adult patients with early-stage MSA to receive 12 months treatment with one of two dose levels of ATH434 or placebo. The results will
provide an opportunity to detect changes in efficacy endpoints to optimize design of a definitive Phase 3 study.
In November 2023 we announced completion of enrollment in the ATH434-201 clinical trial. The study enrolled 77 adults with early-stage
MSA.
In May 2024, we announced that an independent Data Monitoring Committee (DMC) completed its third prespecified review of unblinded
clinical trial data from the ATH434-201 Phase 2 study. Consistent with the first two reviews, the DMC expressed no concerns about safety and
recommended that the study continue as planned without modification. This recommendation is an important milestone as participants are able to safely
tolerate ATH434 as their time on study increases.
The ATH434-201 trial is expected to be completed in November 2024 with topline data expected in January 2025. A presentation of the
ATH434-201 trial was delivered at the American Academy of Neurology (AAN) in April 2024:
●
Title: “A Phase 2 Study of ATH434, a Novel Inhibitor of α-Synuclein Aggregation, for the Treatment of Multiple System Atrophy”
ATH-434-202 Phase 2 Clinical Trial
In May 2023, we initiated a second Phase 2 clinical trial entitled, “A Biomarker Study of ATH434 in Participants with MSA.” The Biomarker
trial is a single arm open label study that will enroll up to 15 individuals with advanced MSA. ATH434-202 study participants will receive treatment with
ATH434 for 12-months. The study will assess the effect of ATH434 treatment on neuroimaging and protein biomarkers to evaluate target engagement, in
addition to clinical measures, safety, and pharmacokinetics. The selected biomarkers include brain iron which is an important contributor to MSA
pathology and an appropriate target to demonstrate drug activity. The primary objective of this study is to evaluate the impact of 12 months treatment
with ATH434 on brain iron by MRI (QSM/R2*) in a more advanced patient population than is being studied in Alterity’s randomized Phase 2 trial.
Subsequent to the end of the fiscal year, in July 2024, we reported positive interim data from the ATH434-202 trial in participants with advanced
MSA. The interim analysis included clinical and biomarker data on 7 participants treated with ATH434 for 6 months and neuroimaging data on 3
participants who were treated for 12 months. After 6 months of treatment, 43% of participants showed improvement on the Unified MSA Rating Scale
(UMSARS), indicating reduced disability on activities of daily living. Over the same period, 29% of participants had stable or improved neurological
symptoms (clinical responders) as assessed by the global impression of change by both the treating physician and the patient. Importantly, the clinical
responders on average had reduced accumulation of iron on MRI in the substantia nigra, putamen and globus pallidus and stable levels of Neurofilament
Light Chain (NFL), a marker of axonal injury, when compared to participants who declined.
Topline data from the ATH434-202 trial is expected in the first half of 2025.
bioMUSE natural history study for individuals with MSA
Biomarkers of progression in Multiple system atrophy (bioMUSE) is a natural history study to track the progression of individuals with early
MSA. The study is being conducted in collaboration with Vanderbilt University Medical Center in the US under the direction of Daniel Claassen, MD,
Professor of Neurology and Principal Investigator. Natural history studies are important for characterizing disease progression in target patient
populations. The goal of the bioMUSE observational study is to optimize patient selection and choose endpoints in the our Phase 2 clinical trials, and the
data generated thus far have been invaluable in informing and reducing risk in these trials.
In May 2024, we hosted a webinar to discuss data from the bioMUSE Natural History Study. The study enrolled 21 individuals who were
observed for 12 months to characterize early-stage MSA in terms of various biomarkers. In particular, the focus is on brain iron, brain volume, and the
pathology in glial support cells. Utilizing novel MRI technology, Alterity’s partners at Vanderbilt have optimized specialized MRI methods, including
machine learning (a form of artificial intelligence), to establish standardized methods to analyze brain iron and brain volumes with precision. Importantly,
they developed a new, novel imaging biomarker to assess brain volume in MSA affected regions. The bioMUSE data showed a statistically significant
increase in iron over 12 months in the substantia nigra, and statistically significant decreases in brain volume observed in affected regions at 12 months.
31
Key data from bioMUSE have been presented at major medical and scientific meetings listed below. The study continues to generate important
scientific data validating our state-of-the-art approach to utilizing various biomarkers to improve the accuracy of diagnosing MSA. Advanced MRI
methods employed in the study, referred to as quantitative susceptibility mapping (QSM), have allowed us to measure iron accumulation in multiple areas
of the brain affected in MSA patients. Similarly, standardized methods have been established to analyze brain volumes with precision.
Findings to date indicate that advanced MRI methods for measuring iron may improve patient selection in clinical trials of disease modifying
therapy and have potential to serve as a biomarker for assessing treatment induced changes. Analysis also demonstrated that wearable sensors can
quantify motor impairment in individuals with MSA that is not captured by neurological examination. This means that wearable sensors can be used to
assess disease progression in clinical trials.
●
April 2024 – American Academy of Neurology (AAN), Title: “Neurofilament Light Chain and Clinical Progression in Early Multiple
System Atrophy”
●
November 2023 – American Autonomic Society (AAS) 34th International Symposium on the Autonomic Nervous System, Title:
“Relationship between N-acetylaspartate and neurofilament light chain in multiple system atrophy”
●
August 2023 – International Congress of Parkinson’s Disease and Movement Disorders (MDS), Titles: “A multimodal approach for
diagnosis of early Multiple System Atrophy”; “Preliminary evidence for evolution of myoinositol and N-acetylaspartate as biomarkers of
disease severity in early-stage Multiple System Atrophy”
●
April 2023 - American Neurological Association, Title: “Wearable Sensors for Quantitative Motor Assessments in MSA”
●
November 2022 - American Autonomic Society, Title: “Urinary symptom profile in early Multiple System Atrophy”
●
October 2022 - American Neurological Association, Title: “Deep Learning Segmentation Improves Precision of Volume Assessment of
Subcortical Structures in early MSA”
●
April 2022 - American Academy of Neurology, Title: “Iron Accumulation Correlates with Disease Severity in Patients with Multiple
System Atrophy”
●
September 2021 - The International Parkinson and Movement Disorder Society Congress, Title: “Non-invasive imaging markers of iron
accumulation in Multiple System Atrophy”
ATH434 Scientific Peer Validation
Scientific interest in ATH434 and validation of our approach to treating neurodegenerative diseases continue to grow, with data from the clinical
trials and natural history study presented at global scientific and clinical conferences.
In November 2021, a poster was presented at the American Autonomic Society 32nd Annual International Symposium. The poster, entitled
“Cardiovascular safety and pharmacokinetics of ATH434, a novel small molecule inhibitor of α-synuclein aggregation, in adults and older adults,
described results from the our Phase 1 clinical trial conducted in healthy volunteers. In this trial, ATH434 was well tolerated in adult and ≥ 65- year-old
volunteers and demonstrated no cardiac adverse event signal and no clinically significant changes in blood pressure or heart rate at any dose. ATH434
also demonstrated dose dependent pharmacokinetics (PK) after single and multiple oral doses and a half-life that supports twice-daily dosing
In April 2024, a poster was presented at the World Orphan Drug Congress, entitled “Biophysical Characteristics of ATH434, a Unique Iron-
Targeting Drug for Treating Friedreich’s Ataxia”. The study evaluated the ability of ATH434 to target the toxic form of iron that drives the pathology of
Friedreich’s Ataxia, a rare neurodegenerative disease that affects young children to young adults. The study also evaluated traditional iron chelators that
are designed to bind iron and remove iron from the body. Conversely, an iron chaperone is designed to bind and redistribute iron within the body.
In November 2023, a poster was presented at the Society for Neuroscience, entitled: “Potent Antioxidant and Mitochondrial- protectant Effects
of ATH434, a Novel Inhibitor of α-Synuclein Aggregation with Moderate Iron- binding Affinity”. The study presented new data indicating that ATH434
can preserve mitochondrial function after oxidative injury and exert direct anti-oxidant activity independent of its iron binding properties, features that
were not observed with another iron binding agent approved for treating iron overload that was also investigated.
32
In January 2022, data in an animal model of MSA was published in the Journal of Parkinson’s Disease. The publication, entitled, “The
Compound ATH434 Prevents Alpha-Synuclein Toxicity in a Murine Model of Multiple System Atrophy” described a study evaluating the efficacy of
ATH434 in genetically altered mice that develop manifestations of MSA. The investigation demonstrated that in the studied brain region, ATH434
treatment reduced both the toxic oligomeric and aggregated forms of α-synuclein, a central nervous system protein important for normal function of nerve
cells. ATH434 treatment also reduced the cardinal pathology of MSA (glial cell inclusions), reduced brain iron, preserved neurons, and improved motor
performance. The results independently confirmed the previous findings from a study published in Movement Disorders in 2021. The 2022 publication
concluded that ATH434 is a promising small molecule drug candidate that has potential for treating MSA. The study was led by David I. Finkelstein,
Ph.D., Head of Parkinson’s Disease Laboratory at the Florey Institute of Neuroscience and Mental Health and the University of Melbourne.
In June 2021, Movement Disorders, published results from a study demonstrating that ATH434 reduces α-synuclein related neurodegeneration in
a widely accepted murine model of MSA. The study was performed at the Laboratory for Translational Neurodegeneration Research, Department of
Neurology, Medical University of Innsbruck in Austria, a leading laboratory of animal research in MSA, under the direction of Professor Nadia
Stefanova. The pre-clinical study showed that treatment with ATH434 was neuroprotective and improved motor function.
In July 2021, Plos ONE published an in vitro study concluding that the novel mechanism of action of ATH434 provides a compelling case for its
continued development as a therapeutic agent in neurodegenerative diseases associated with iron accumulation.
Patents and Licenses
Patent Matters
Patent matters in biotechnology are highly uncertain and involve complex legal and factual questions. Accordingly, the availability and breadth
of claims allowed in biotechnology and pharmaceutical patents cannot be predicted. Statutory differences in patentable subject matter may limit the
protection we can obtain on some or all of our inventions outside Australia or prevent us from obtaining patent protection outside Australia, either of
which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. For example, methods of treating humans are not patentable in
many countries outside Australia and the United States. Moreover, since patent applications are not published until at least 18 months from their first
filing date and the publication of discoveries in the scientific literature often lags behind actual discoveries, we cannot be certain that we or any of our
licensors were the first creator of inventions covered by pending patent applications or that we or our licensors were the first to file patent applications for
such inventions. Additionally, the grant and enforceability of a patent is dependent on a number of factors that may vary between jurisdictions. These
factors may include the novelty of the invention, the requirement that the invention not be obvious in the light of prior art (including prior use or
publication of the invention), the utility of the invention, and the extent to which the patent clearly describes the best method of working the invention.
While we intend to seek patent protection for our therapeutic candidate products and technologies, we cannot be certain that any of the pending
or future patent applications filed by us or on our behalf will be approved, or that we will develop additional proprietary products or processes that are
patentable or that we will be able to license any other patentable products or processes. We also cannot be certain that others will not independently
develop similar products or processes, duplicate any of the products or processes developed or being developed by us or licensed to us, or design around
the patents owned or licensed by us, or that any patents owned or licensed by us will provide us with competitive advantages. Furthermore, we cannot be
certain that patents held by third parties will not prevent the commercialisation of products incorporating the technology developed by us or licensed to
us, or that third parties will not challenge or seek to narrow, invalidate or circumvent any of the issued, pending or future patents owned or licensed by us.
33
Our commercial success will also depend, in part, on our ability to avoid infringement of patents issued to others. If a court of competent
jurisdiction determines that we were infringing any third party patents, we could be required to pay damages, alter our products or processes, obtain
licenses or cease certain activities. We cannot be certain that the licenses required under patents held by third parties would be made available on terms
acceptable to us or at all. To the extent that we are unable to obtain such licenses, we could be foreclosed from the development, export, manufacture or
commercialisation of the product requiring such license or encounter delays in product introductions while we attempt to design around such patents, and
any of these circumstances could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We may have to resort to litigation to enforce any patents issued or licensed to us or to determine the scope and validity of third-party
proprietary rights. Such litigation could result in substantial costs and diversion of effort by us. We may have to participate in opposition proceedings
before the Australian Patent and Trademark Office or another foreign patent office, or in interference proceedings declared by the U.S. Patent and
Trademark Office, to determine the priority of invention for patent applications filed by competitors. Any such litigation, interference or opposition
proceeding, regardless of outcome, could be expensive and time consuming, and adverse determinations in any such proceedings could prevent us from
developing, manufacturing or commercializing our products and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
In addition to patent protection, we rely on unpatented trade secrets, know-how and other confidential information as well as proprietary
technological innovation and expertise. Although we have taken steps to protect our trade secrets and unpatented know-how, including entering into
confidentiality agreements with third parties, and confidential information and inventions agreements with employees, consultants and advisers, third
parties may still obtain this information or come upon this same or similar information independently.
Patent Portfolio
Since June 30, 2023, we have continued to advance our patent portfolio that aligns with our development programs.
We previously reported the filing of a patent family claiming over 150 imidazo[l,5-a]pyridine compounds that modulate biological iron and are
potentially useful for the treatment of neurological diseases such as Parkinson’s disease and Alzheimer’s disease. The patent was filed under the United
States expedited review procedure, known as Track One, and we announced allowance of the United States application No. 16/818,641 on November 16,
2020 and its granting on July 1, 2021. In securing the patent grant, no prior art was cited against the application. A national phase application driving
priority from PCT application, No. PCT/AU2020/050235 was filed in September 2021 in each of Europe, Japan, China, Canada, Australia and India. On
August 23, 2023, a European Patent was granted, patent number 3938364.
We also previously reported that on June 18, 2020, we filed a provisional application to register a patent that claims an additional 80 novel
compounds, also that modulate biological iron and also titled “Compounds for and Methods of Treating Diseases”. This application matured to a PCT
application No. PCT/AU2021/050633 on June 18, 2021. Similar to the first mentioned patent application, contemporaneously with filing the PCT
application on April 23, 2021, we also filed United States complete, application No. 17/239,375, under Track One. We announced allowance of the
United States application on August 4, 2021, and in securing the allowance, no prior art was cited against the application. On October 26, 2021, the
application was granted as US patent no. 11155547. The application is currently under examination in Europe. An application has been filed in Australia
and awaits examination. The filed application is in the examination process in China, the European Patent Office, and Japan.
On August 27, 2021, we filed a PCT application No. PCT/AU2021/050,986 to register a patent that claims an additional 150 novel compounds,
all of which modulate biological Zinc for the potential treatment of cancer, neurological diseases and infectious diseases, and is titled “Compounds for
and Methods of Treating Diseases”. On the same date we also filed a United States complete application, application No. 17/459854, under United States
track 1 expedited review procedure. The patent was granted in the US on February 23, 2023, patent number 11603364.
On September 24, 2023, we filed a provisional application in the USA to register a patent that claims a method of use ATH434 and related
compounds in non-neurologic diseases. We intend to convert this to a nonprovisional in September 2024.
On July 12, 2024, we filed a provisional application No. 63/670299 to register a patent that claims a dosing method for use by ATH434 for the
treatment of neurological disease supported by clinical data.
On July 31, 2024, we filed a provisional application with No. 2024902369 claiming 39 novel compounds potentially useful for the treatment of
neurological and non-neurological diseases.
34
Patent
Status
Invention
“8-Hydroxyquinoline Derivatives”
Filed: July 16, 2003
PCT/AU03/00914
Patent in the USA has been Granted.
The invention is directed to chemical scaffolds of
the 8-Hydroxyquinoline compounds class and their
utility in the treatment of neurological conditions.
8-hydroxy and 8-mercapto quinazolinones
Filed October 3, 2003
PCT/AU2003/001303
Expiry June 7, 2026
The Invention is directed towards Follow-up
Scaffolds and their utility in the treatment of
neurological conditions, Covers ATH434
composition of matter.
“Neurologically - Active Compounds”
Filed: April 1, 2005
PCT/AU2005/000477
Patents have been Granted in Australia, the
USA, Germany, Spain, France, Great Britain,
and Italy.
The invention is directed to ‘F4’ quinazolinone
chemical structures and their utility in the treatment
of neurological conditions and includes Parkinson’s
Disease lead compounds. It covers the ATH434
composition of matter.
“Quinazolinone compounds”
Filed: December 24, 2008
PCT/AU2009/001701
Patents have been Granted in Australia , the
USA, Germany, Spain, France, Great Britain,
and Italy.
The invention is directed to 2,3 disubstituted
quinazolinone compounds used in the treatment of
Parkinson’s Disease.
“Method of treating immunoglobulin light chain
amyloidosis”
Filed: July 1, 2016
PCT/AU2017/050678
Patent in the USA and Japan has been Granted.
The invention is directed to the treatment of light
chain amyloidosis with a known compound.
“Compounds for Methods of Treating
Diseases”
Filed: March 13, 2020
PCT/AU2020/050235
A US patent and an EP patent have been granted.
National phase applications have been filed in
Germany, Spain, France, Great Britain, and Italy.
Examination processes are underway in Japan,
and Australia.
The invention is directed to 150 novel compounds
and their utility in the treatment of
neurodegenerative diseases.
“Compounds for Methods of Treating Diseases”
Filed: June 18, 2021
PCT/AU2021/050633
A US patent has been granted. An application
has been filed in Australia and awaits
examination. The filed application is in the exam
process in China, EP, and Japan.
The invention is directed to 80 novel compounds
and their utility in the treatment of
neurodegenerative diseases
“Novel Therapy”
Filed: September 22, 2023
PCT application No. 63/584,790
Provisional application filed in the US.
Nonprovisional application to be filed in
September 2024.
This invention is directed method of use of
ATH434 and related compounds in non-neurologic
diseases. Co-inventorship with personnel from State
University of Buffalo in New York (USA).
“Novel Therapy”
Filed: July 12, 2024
PCT application No. 63/670299
Provisional application filed in the US.
This invention is directed to clinical method of
dosing of ATH434 in neurological disorders such as
Multiple System Atrophy.
“Compounds for and Methods of Treating
Disease”
Filed: July 31, 2024
PCT application No. 2024902369
Provisional PCT application
This invention is directed to 39 novel compounds
and their utility in the treatment of
neurodegenerative diseases.
35
Competition
The pharmaceutical industry is extremely competitive. We believe that we will face competition in differing levels of intensity in all of the areas
in which we are conducting research. ATH434, if approved for the treatment of MSA, may compete in a highly competitive market. Our competitors,
which are located worldwide, are numerous and include, among others, major pharmaceutical companies, biotechnology firms, universities and other
research institutions. These competitors may develop technologies and products that are more effective than any that we are developing, or which would
render our technology and products obsolete or non-competitive. Many of these competitors have greater financial, research and screening capabilities,
technical resources and manufacturing and marketing capabilities than we do. In addition, many of our competitors may have more experience than we do
in non-clinical and human clinical trials of new or improved drugs, as well as in obtaining FDA, EMA, TGA and other regulatory approvals. We cannot
provide assurance that we can compete effectively with these other competitor companies.
There are currently no approved drugs for the treatment of Multiple System Atrophy (MSA). If we are able to successfully develop ATH434 and
gain approval for the treatment of MSA, we may compete with the following drug candidates which are in development:
●
Lu AF82422: This product is being developed by H. Lundbeck A/S. It is administered by injection and is thought to act by interfering with
the extracellular spread of the α-synuclein protein. In January 2024, Lundbeck reported that their Phase 2 trial did not show statistical
significance on its primary endpoint of slowing the rate of progression of MSA.
●
TAK-341/MEDI341: This product is being developed by Takeda in partnership with AstraZeneca. It is administered by injection and is
thought to act by interfering with the extracellular spread of the α-synuclein protein. A Phase 2 study is being planned.
●
Ono-2808: Ono Pharmaceuticals is developing this S1P5 receptor agonist. It is an oral gent thought to act by promoting myelin synthesis. A
Phase 2 clinical trial is ongoing.
●
AAV-GDNF: AskBio is developing this gene therapy. It is administered in spinal fluid and is thought to reduce abnormal protein
accumulation. A Phase 1/2 study is ongoing.
●
TEV-56286(formerly/Anle138b): This product is being developed by Teva Pharmaceuticals. It is an oral agent and is thought to act as a
non-specific inhibitor of protein aggregation. A Phase 2 trial is ongoing.
C.
ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE
We have two wholly-owned subsidiaries, Alterity Therapeutics Inc. and Alterity Therapeutics UK Limited, incorporated in the United States and
the United Kingdom, respectively.
D.
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
Our executive offices are located at Level 14, 350 Collins Street, Melbourne, VIC 3000, Australia, where we occupy approximately 105 square
meters. The lease for the facility, which expires on 31 May 2026 has an annual rent of A$54,727. Our United States office is located at Suite 360, 39899
Balentine Drive, Newark, California 94560, United States of America, where we occupy approximately 911 square feet. The lease for the facility, which
expires on May 31, 2024, and has been extended to May 31,2025 has an annual rent of U.S.$27,558. We also utilize a facility at 30 Flemington Rd,
Parkville, VIC 3010, Australia, where we occupy approximately 44 square meters. The lease for the facility has been extended to 31 July,2025 and has an
annual rent of A$16,157.
36
ITEM 4A. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
Not applicable.
ITEM 5. OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS
The following discussion and analysis includes certain forward-looking statements with respect to the business, financial condition and results
of operations of our company. The words “estimate,” “project,” “intend,” “expect” and similar expressions are intended to identify forward-looking
statements within the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These forward-looking statements are subject to risks and uncertainties that could
cause actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by such forward-looking statements, including those risk factors contained in Item 3.D.
of this annual report. You should read the following discussion and analysis in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the notes
thereto included in this annual report.
A.
OPERATING RESULTS
Background
We were incorporated under the laws of the Commonwealth of Australia on November 11, 1997. The principal listing of our ordinary shares and
listed options to purchase our ordinary shares is on the ASX. From September 5, 2002 until April 8, 2019, our ADSs traded on the NASDAQ Capital
Market under the symbol “PRAN.” On April 8, 2019 we changed our name to Alterity Therapeutics Limited and our ADSs have traded under the symbol
“ATHE” and our ordinary shares have traded under the symbol “ATH” since that date.
Our consolidated financial statements appearing in this annual report comply with IFRS as issued by IASB. In this annual report, all references
to “U.S. dollars” or “U.S.$” are to the currency of the United States, and all references to “Australian dollars” or “A$” are to the currency of Australia.
All of our revenues are generated in Australian dollars, except for interest earned on foreign currency bank accounts, and the majority of our expenses are
incurred in Australian dollars.
Overview
We are a development stage enterprise at an early to mid-stage in the development of our pharmaceutical products that are designed to treat the
underlying causes of neurodegeneration of the brain. We have incurred net losses since inception and expect to incur substantial and increasing losses for
the next several years as we expand our research and development activities and move our product candidates into later stages of development. All of our
product candidates are in discovery phase or early and mid-stage of development and we face the risks of failure inherent in developing drugs based on
new technologies. The process of carrying out the development of our products to later stages of development may require significant additional research
and development expenditures, including nonclinical testing and clinical trials, as well as for obtaining regulatory approval. To date, we have funded our
operations primarily through the sale of equity securities, proceeds from the exercise of options, government grants, licensing and research collaborations
and interest income.
Since completing our initial public offering and listing process on the ASX on March 28, 2000, we have concentrated our resources toward the
pursuit of our disease targets. We have completed four Phase 1 studies of PBT2 and a Phase 2a clinical trial for PBT2 in patients with Alzheimer’s
disease. We have completed the “IMAGINE” Phase 2 biomarker imaging trial in Alzheimer’s disease and a fifty-two week open label IMAGINE
Extension study and the “Reach2HD” Phase 2a trial in Huntington disease. In 2019, we completed a Phase I clinical trial of ATH434 in healthy
volunteers and in 2022 we commenced a Phase 2 clinical trial of ATH434 in Multiple System Atrophy (MSA), a rare and highly debilitating Parkinsonian
disorder. For details regarding clinical trials for our lead compounds, see Item 4.B. “Information on the Company - Business Overview - Clinical Trials
for Our Product Candidates.”
37
Going Concern Basis
The Group is a development stage medical biotechnology company and as such expects to be utilizing sources of cash funding until its research
activities have become marketable. The Group has incurred recurring losses since inception including a net loss of $19,123,464 in the year ended 30 June
2024 (2023: $13,806,515) and a net operating cash outflow of $12,605,824 in the year ended 30 June 2024 (2023: $20,035,837). The Group expects to
continue incurring losses into the foreseeable future and will need to raise additional capital to continue the development of its planned research and
development programs. The continuing viability of the Group is subject to its ability to raise additional capital to finance the continuation of its planned
research and development programs, maintaining implemented cost containment and deferment strategies, and successfully commercializing its
initiatives. The Group intends to raise new equity funding within six months of the financial year end to enable progression of its planned research and
development programs, however there is uncertainty associated with its ability to successfully raise such funds in the time and amounts needed to meet its
requirements.
The inability to obtain funding, as and when needed, would have a negative impact on the Group’s financial condition and ability to pursue its
business strategies. If the Group is unable to obtain the required funding to operate and to develop and commercialize its product candidates, it could be
forced to delay, reduce or eliminate some or all of its research and development programs, which would adversely affect its business prospects.
As a result of these matters, there is a material uncertainty that may cast significant doubt (or raise substantial doubt as contemplated by Public
Company Accounting Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) standards) on the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and, therefore, that it may be unable
to realize its assets and discharge its liabilities in the normal course of business. These consolidated financial statements have been prepared assuming the
Group will continue as a going concern which contemplates the continuity of operations, realization of assets and the satisfaction of liabilities in the
ordinary course of business and do not include adjustments that would result if the Group were unable to continue as a going concern.
Significant Costs and Expenses
Research and development expenses. Our research and development expenses consist primarily of expenses for contracted research and
development activities conducted by third parties on our behalf. Research and development expenses also include costs associated with the acquisition,
development of patents and salaries and fees paid to employees and consultants involved in research and development activities.
General and administration expenses. Our general and administration expenses consist of (i) personnel expenses such as directors’ fees, salaries
and benefits paid to employees and officers and equity-based payments awarded to directors, officers and employees; (ii) auditor and accounting
expenses which are fees paid to our auditors for services related to annual reports and interim reports filed or submitted in Australia and the United States
and fees paid to other accounting firms in respect of tax and other accounting advice; (iii) public relations and marketing expenses which are fees paid to
outside consultants for services related to ASX and SEC announcements and presentations; (iv) depreciation expenses; and (v) other administrative and
office expenses.
Intellectual property expenses. Our intellectual property expenses consist of fees paid to our outside counsel for legal fees associated with patent
applications and for the defence of patents.
Other gains and losses. Other gains and losses consist of foreign exchange gain (loss) which are the net unrealized gain or loss on cash balances
and trade and other payables held in foreign currencies (primarily U.S. dollars, British Pounds and Euros) as well as net realized gains and losses on
foreign currency transactions.
38
Results of Operations
Year ended June 30, 2024 compared to year ended June 30, 2023
Interest income
Interest income increased to A$268,419 for the year ended June 30, 2024 from A$16,436 for the year ended June 30, 2023, an increase of
A$251,983, or 1,533.1%. The increase in interest income is primarily attributable to higher Australian dollar cash balances with higher interest rates
during the current fiscal year.
Other Income
We have recognised a receivable and other income of A$4,019,285 for the R&D Tax Incentive refundable cash offset in relation to eligible
expenditure for the year ended June 30, 2024, on which we are entitled to a 43.5% refundable offset under an Australian R&D tax incentive scheme that
was introduced on July 1, 2019.
For the year ended June 30, 2023, we recognised a receivable and other income of A$3,914,230 for the R&D Tax Incentive refundable cash
offset in relation to eligible expenditure for the year.
Research and development expenses
Our research and development expenses increased to A$18,644,047 for the year ended June 30, 2024 from A$13,198,583 for the year ended
June 30, 2023, an increase of A$5,445,464 or 41.3%. The increase is attributable to certain research and development studies during the current year.
General and administrative expenses
General and administrative expenses decreased to A$4,762,643 for the year ended June 30, 2024 from A$5,056,571 for the year ended June 30,
2023, a decrease of A$293,928 or 5.8%. The decrease is mainly attributable to management’s efforts in reducing expenses and preserving cash.
Intellectual property expenses
Intellectual property expenses, which include patent portfolio costs and intellectual property related legal costs, decreased to A$214,304 for the
year ended June 30, 2024 from A$285,067 for the year ended June 30, 2023, a decrease of A$70,763 or 24.8%. This decrease is mainly due to
management’s efforts in reducing expenses and preserving cash.
Foreign exchange gain (loss)
We recorded a foreign exchange gain of A$261,152 for the year ended June 30, 2024 compared to a foreign exchange gain of A$917,650 for the
year ended June 30, 2023. Foreign exchange gain (loss) reflects the impact of changes in foreign currency exchange rates on cash that we hold in U.S.
dollars, British Pounds and Euros. In the 2024 and 2023 fiscal year, the Australian dollar depreciated against the U.S. dollar, which had a favorable
impact on the Australian dollar value of our cash held in U.S. dollars. In the 2024 fiscal year, we incurred a foreign exchange gain of A$260,356
attributable to the cash balances that we held in U.S. dollars, and a foreign exchange gain of A$796 attributable to foreign currency transactions. In the
2023 fiscal year, we incurred a foreign exchange gain of A$914,942 attributable to the cash balances that we held in U.S. dollars, and a foreign exchange
gain of A$2,708 attributable to foreign currency transactions.
39
For a comparison of our results of operations between year ended June 30, 2023 and year ended June 2022, see Item 5.A. “Results of
Operations” of our annual report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC on August 31, 2023.
Inflation and Seasonality
Management believes inflation has not had a material impact on our company’s operations or financial condition and that our operations are not
currently subject to seasonal influences.
Conditions in Australia
We are incorporated under the laws of, and our principal offices and research and development facilities are located in, the Commonwealth of
Australia. Therefore, we are directly affected by political and economic conditions in Australia. See Item 3.D. “Key Information – Risk Factors – Risks
Relating to Our Location in Australia” for a description of factors that could materially affect our operations.
Recently Issued International Accounting Standards and Pronouncements
New and amended Accounting Standards and Interpretations issued and effective
There were no new or amended standards adopted by the Group in the year ended June 30, 2024 that materially impacted the Group. These
financial statements follow the same accounting policies as compared to the June 30, 2023 consolidated financial statements and related notes as filed
with the Australian Securities Exchange and the Securities and Exchange Commission.
Australian Disclosure Requirements
Dividends
No dividends have been paid during the financial year (2024: nil). The Directors do not recommend the payment of a dividend in respect of the
current financial year (2023: nil).
Significant changes in the state of affairs
There have been no significant changes in the state of affairs of the Group during the year.
Events since the end of the financial year
No other matters or circumstances have arisen since June 30, 2024 that have significantly affected the Group’s operations, results or state of
affairs, or may do so in future years.
Likely developments and expected results of operations
The likely developments in our operations, to the extent that such matters can be commented upon, are covered in Item 5A of this report.
Environmental regulation
We are involved in scientific research and development, and the activities do not create any significant environmental impact to any material
extent. Our scientific research activities are in full compliance with all prescribed environmental regulations.
40
B.
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
We are a development stage company, have had no sales income to date and as of June 30, 2024, our accumulated deficit totaled
A$214,161,131. We had A$12,638,885 of cash and cash equivalents as of June 30, 2024, compared to A$15,773,783 as of June 30, 2023.
From inception until our initial public offering in March 2000 we financed our operations primarily through borrowings from two of our then
directors, which were repaid from the proceeds of such offering. Since our initial public offering, we have financed our operations primarily through sales
of equity securities, proceeds from the exercise of options, government grants, licensing and research collaborations and interest earned on investments.
In November 2023, we received commitments for a capital raising of $4.8 million by means of a private placement. The private placement was
conducted at 0.0035 per new share. For every new share issued, one free attaching short-dated option was issued.
In February 2024, we received commitments for a capital raising of $3.25 million by means of a Placement. The Placement was conducted at
0.0038 per new share. For every three new share issued, one free attaching listed option was issued.
In February 2024, we received commitments for a capital raising of $2 million by means of a Securities Purchase Plan. The number of securities
issued to the SPP participants on 2 February 2024 following the scaleback and pursuant to ASX Listing Rule 7.1, and which are within the volumes
approved by shareholders at the EGM, are:
●
571,428,556 SPP Shares at A$0.0035 (0.35 Australian cents) per SPP Share (ASX:ATH); and
●
571,428,556 unlisted Short-Dated Options (each with an exercise price of A$0.007, expiring on 31 August 2024) (ASX: ATHAAI); and
●
190,476,123 listed Long-Dated Options (each with an exercise price of A$0.01, expiring on 31 August 2026) (ASX: ATHO).
On February 15, 2024 we entered into a Sales Agreement, or the Sales Agreement, with JonesTrading Institutional Services LLC, or
JonesTrading, under which we may issue and sell ADSs from time to time pursuant to a Prospectus Supplement through JonesTrading acting as agent.
Subject to the terms and conditions of the Sales Agreement, JonesTrading will use its commercially reasonable efforts to sell the ADSs from time to time,
based upon our instructions. JonesTrading is entitled to a commission at a fixed commission rate equal to 3.0% of the gross sales price per shares sold.
Sales of the ADSs under the Sales Agreement may be made by any method permitted by law deemed to be an “at the market offering” as defined in Rule
415 of the Securities Act Regulations. On February 15, 2024, we filed a Prospectus Supplement relating to the offering of up to US$6,000,000 in ADSs
with the SEC.
As of June 30, 2024, we had a total of 3,250 billion unlisted and listed unexercised options outstanding. The options have exercise prices ranging
from A$0.02 to A$0.09. If all unlisted options were exercised, we would receive consideration of A$28.6 million in total.
From inception to June 30, 2024, our capital expenditures have totaled A$849,729, consisting of computer equipment, furniture and fixtures, fit-
out costs and laboratory equipment that is being used in connection with our research facility at The University of Melbourne. Capital expenditures for
equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of 3 to 20 years, with a net balance as of June 30, 2024 of A$32,154. We
currently do not have significant capital spending requirements, but we expect to continue to engage in capital spending consistent with anticipated
growth in our operations and personnel.
We believe the Australian Government tax incentive scheme relating to eligible research and development activities, introduced on July 1, 2011,
will provide us with significant benefits in future years. Such eligible R&D activities include but are not limited to:
●
Core activities, which are experimental activities whose outcome cannot be known or determined in advance, but can only be determined by
applying a systematic progression of work;
●
Core activities conducted for the purpose of generating new knowledge (including new knowledge in the form of new or improved
processes and materials); or
●
Supporting activities that are directly related and designed to support the above.
Under the research and development tax incentive scheme, entities with an aggregated turnover for the income year of less than A$20 million
will be entitled to a 43.5% refundable tax incentive. In the year ended June 30, 2024, we recorded A$4.0 million in other income with respect to funds we
will receive in relation to the 2024 financial year under the research and development tax incentive scheme.
We have incurred recurring losses since inception, including operating losses of $19.1 million and $13.8 million for the years ended June 30,
2024 and 2023, respectively, and an operating cash outflow of $12.6 million and $20 million, respectively. We expect to continue incurring losses into
the foreseeable future and will need to raise additional capital to continue the development of our planned research and development programs, and as a
result, this creates a material uncertainty that may cast significant doubt (or raise substantial doubt as contemplated by the Public Company Accounting
Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) standards) on our ability to continue as a going concern and therefore, that we may be unable to realize our assets and
discharge our liabilities in the normal course of business. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared assuming that we will continue as a
going concern, which contemplates the realization of its assets and the satisfaction of our liabilities in the normal course of business.
41
Cash Flows
The following table summarizes our cash flows for the periods presented:
Year ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
(A$)
Net cash (used) in operating activities
(12,605,824)
(20,035,837)
(12,337,274)
Net cash used in investing activities
(5,722)
(36,461)
(89,147)
Net cash generated from financing activities
9,216,292
124,340
16,304,558
Net increase(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
(3,395,254)
(19,947,958)
3,878,137
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
15,773,783
34,806,799
28,115,516
Exchange rate adjustments on cash held in foreign currencies
260,356
914,942
2,813,146
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
12,638,885
15,773,783
34,806,799
Net cash used in operating activities was A$12,605,824, A$20,035,837 and A$12,337,274 during the years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022,
respectively. Our payments to suppliers and employees during the years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022 were A$21,393,136, A$19,943,617 and
A$16,875,144, respectively. Our operating activity receipts for the years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022 of A$8,583,477, Nil and A$4,126,364
consisted of R&D tax incentive refunds. The A$1,449,519 increase in payments to suppliers and employees for the year ended June 30, 2024 when
compared to the year ended June 30, 2023 reflects the increase in activity during the year due to conduct of the Phase 2 study of ATH434. During the
years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022, our payments to suppliers and employees was offset in part by interest received of A$269,075, A$15,798 and
A$2,755 respectively.
Net cash used in investing activities was A$5,722, A$36,461 and A$89,147 during the years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022, respectively.
Cash flows used for investing activities was primarily attributable to payments for purchase of property and equipment for the years ended June 30, 2024,
2023 and 2022.
Net cash generated from financing activities was A$9,216,292, A$124,340 and A$16,304,558 for the years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022.
Cash generated from financing activities in the year ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022 related to proceeds from the issuance of shares amounting to
A$10,144,682, A$316,675 and A$17,176,040 respectively.
An unrealized foreign exchange gain of A$260,356 was incurred for the year ended June 30, 2024 an unrealized foreign exchange gain of
A$914,942 was incurred for the year ended June 30, 2023 and an unrealized foreign exchange gain of A$2,813,146 was incurred for the year ended 2022.
In 2024, the Australian dollar depreciated against the U.S. dollar by 0.35%. In 2023, the Australian dollar depreciated against the U.S. dollar by 3.60%. In
2022, the Australian dollar depreciated against the U.S. dollar by 8.19%.
C.
RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT, PATENTS AND LICENSES
In recent years, we have continued our practice of building valuable research collaborations with institutes based in Australia, the United States
and other countries to enable us to investigate a variety of therapeutic indications including Alzheimer’s disease, Huntington disease, Parkinsonian
movement disorders and selected cancers. These collaborative arrangements ensure that we work with well-respected laboratories with specific expertise
in screening and animal modelling of relevance to the particular indication, without incurring ongoing administrative and personnel costs. We maintain
in-house patent counsel and research and development project expertise to coordinate these research collaborations.
Our research and development expenses consist primarily of expenses for contracted research and development activities conducted by third
parties on our behalf, including personnel, testing facilities and other payments in accordance with our research and clinical agreements. Research and
development expenses also include costs associated with the acquisition and development of patents. Due to the numerous variables and the uncertain
nature of the development of a clinical compound, including obtaining regulatory approvals, we are not able to reasonably estimate the nature, timing and
costs of the future expenditures necessary to complete our research and development projects, the anticipated completion dates of each project and when
material net cash flows from our research and development programs will commence.
42
When a product candidate is identified as suitable for clinical development, we establish a project team to coordinate all non-clinical and clinical
development and manufacturing activities. Typically, we engage a clinical research organization to manage patient enrollment, data management, clinical
site coordination and statistical analysis, as is the case with the development of our lead compound ATH434 through Phase 1 and 2 development. We
manage our manufacturing campaigns through clinical manufacturing organisations for quality assurance and GMP compliance. All clinical, non-clinical,
clinical development and manufacturing of our compounds is performed in compliance with the appropriate governing authorities, regulators and
standards (for example, the International Conference on Harmonisation of Technical Requirements for Registration of Pharmaceuticals for Human Use).
Our technology does not currently require the licensing of enabling technology licenses or freedom to operate licenses. Our product candidates
are designed and synthesised by our employees and the intellectual property of such product candidates is owned by us.
D.
TREND INFORMATION
We are a development stage company and while we believe that our technology will offer novel therapeutic strategies into an expanding market,
we cannot predict with any degree of accuracy the outcome of our research or commercialisation efforts.
We have not commercialised any products to date. Accordingly, any trends within the markets in which we operate are expected to have more
direct impact on our business in the event that we are successful in commercialising our product candidates, including ATH434 and new candidate
products.
We will need substantial additional funding in order to complete the development, testing and commercialisation of our product candidates. The
commitment to these projects will require additional external funding, at least until we are able to generate sufficient cash flow from sale of one or more
of our products to support our continued operations. If adequate funding is not available, we may be required to delay, scale back or eliminate certain
aspects of our operations or attempt to obtain funds through unfavorable arrangements with partners or others that may force us to relinquish rights to
certain of our technologies, products or potential markets or that could impose onerous financial or other terms. Management is continuing its efforts to
obtain additional funds so that we can meet our obligations and sustain operations. See Note 1 (Going Concern Basis) of our accompanying financial
statements.
E.
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES
Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated and are based on historical experience and other factors, including expectations of future
events that may have a financial impact on the entity and that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances.
We make estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates will, by definition, seldom equal the related
actual results. The estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities
within the next financial year are discussed below.
Share-based Payments
The value attributed to share options and remuneration shares issued is an estimate calculated using an appropriate mathematical formula based
on an option pricing model. The choice of models and the resultant option value require assumptions to be made in relation to the likelihood and timing
of the conversion of the options to shares and the value and volatility of the price of the underlying shares.
43
Clinical Trial Accruals
Clinical trial costs are charged to research and development expense as incurred. We accrue for expenses resulting from contracts with CROs,
investigators and consultants, and under certain other agreements in connection with conducting clinical trials. The financial terms of these contracts are
subject to negotiations, which vary from contract to contract and may result in payment flows that do not match the periods over which materials or
services are provided. Our objective is to reflect the appropriate trial expense in the financial statements by matching the appropriate expenses with the
period in which services and efforts are expended. In the event advance payments are made to a CRO, the payments will be recorded as a prepaid clinical
trial expenses, which will be expensed as services are rendered.
The CRO contracts generally include pass-through fees including, but not limited to, regulatory expenses, investigator fees, travel costs and
other miscellaneous costs, including shipping and printing fees. We estimate our clinical accruals based on reports from and discussion with clinical
personnel and outside services providers as to the progress or state of completion of trials, or the services completed. We estimate accrued expenses as of
each balance sheet date based on the facts and circumstances known at that time. Our clinical trial accrual is dependent, in part, upon the receipt of timely
and accurate reporting from the CROs and other third-party vendors.
R&D Tax Incentives
The Australian Government replaced the research and development tax concession with the research and development tax incentive from July 1,
2011. The provisions provide refundable or non-refundable tax offsets. The research and development tax incentive applies to expenditure incurred and
the use of depreciating assets in an income year commencing on or after July 1, 2011. A 43.5% refundable tax offset will be available to eligible small
companies with an annual aggregate turnover of less than $20 million. Management has assessed these activities and expenditure to determine which are
likely to be eligible under the incentive scheme. For the period to June 30, 2024 the Group has recorded an item in other income of A$4.0 million (2023:
A$3.9 million, 2022: A$4.7 million) to recognize this amount which relates to this period.
44
ITEM 6. DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES
(Start of the Remuneration Report for Australian Disclosure Requirements)
A.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
Our directors and executive officers are as follows:
Name
Age
Position
Geoffrey P. Kempler
69
Chairman of the Board of Directors
David A. Stamler
63
Chief Executive Officer
Lawrence B. Gozlan
45
Director
Peter A. Marks(1) (2)
68
Director
Brian D. Meltzer(1)(2)
70
Director
Kathryn Andrews (3)
57
Chief Financial Officer
Phillip Hains
64
Company Secretary and Chief Financial Officer
(1) Member of the Audit Committee
(2) Member of the Remuneration Committee and Share Plan Committee
(3) Kathryn Andrews resigned 30 January 2024
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler has served as Chairman of our Board of Directors since November 1997; between November 1997 and August 2004 he
served as our Chief Executive Officer and again assumed the position of Chief Executive Officer from June 2005 until January 2021. Mr. Kempler is one
of the founders of our company.
Mr. Kempler qualified as psychologist with extensive experience in investment and business development. He served as a Chairman and Non-
Executive Director of Opthea Limited (NASDAQ:OPT), from November 2015 until October 2020, is immediate past Chairman of Ausbiotech,
Australia’s biotechnology organization, and is a member of the Industry Advisory Board at the Turner Institute of Brain and Mental Health at Monash
University, and Chair of Hexima Ltd. Mr. Kempler holds a B.Sc degree in science from Monash University, Grad. Dip. App. Soc. Psych. degree from
Swinburne University.
Dr. David Stamler, M.D. was appointed Chief Executive Officer in January 2021 and previously served as our Chief Medical Officer and
Senior Vice President, Clinical Development since May 2017. Prior to joining Alterity, Dr. Stamler served as the Vice President, Clinical Development
and Therapeutic Head for Movement Disorders at Teva Pharmaceutical Industries from 2015 to 2017 after Teva acquired Auspex Pharmaceuticals. Dr
Stamler was the Chief Medical Officer of Auspex from January 2011 until 2015. Dr. Stamler received an M.D. from the University of Chicago—The
Pritzker School of Medicine and a B.A. in Biology from the University of Chicago.
45
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan has served as a director of our Group since August 2011. Mr. Gozlan, a leading biotechnology investor and advisor, is
the Chief Investment Officer and Founder of Scientia Capital, a specialised global investment fund focused exclusively in life sciences. Scientia Capital
was founded to provide high level expertise and to manage investments for high net worth individuals, family offices and institutional investors wanting
exposure to the biotechnology industry. Prior to this, Mr. Gozlan was responsible for the largest biotechnology investment portfolio in Australia as the
institutional biotechnology analyst at QIC (“the Queensland Investment Corporation”), an investment fund with over A$60 billion under management. He
previously worked as the senior biotechnology analyst in the equities team at Foster Stockbroking Pty Ltd and gained senior corporate finance experience
advising life sciences companies at Deloitte. Mr. Gozlan is currently a Director of Opthea Limited, (NASDAQ:OPT). He holds a Bachelor of Science
with Honors in microbiology and immunology from the University of Melbourne.
Mr. Peter Marks has served as a director of our Group since July 2005. Peter has over 35 years’ experience in corporate advisory and
investment banking. Over the course of his long career, he has specialised in capital raisings, IPOs, cross border, M&A transactions, corporate
underwriting and venture capital transactions for companies in Australia, the United States and Israel. He has been involved in a broad range of
transactions with a special focus in the life sciences, biotechnology, medical technology and high tech segments. Mr. Marks served as a director on the
Board of Elsight Limited (ASX:ELS) between January 2020 and October 2021, on the Board of Nyrada Inc. (ASX:NYR) between January 2020 and
August 2022, and currently serves on the Board of Noxopharm Limited (ASX:NOX) (appointed in March 2016) and EverGreen Lithium Limited
(ASX:EG1) (appointed in January 2022). Mr. Marks has a MBA, Bachelor of Economics, Bachelor of Law, and Grad Dip in Commercial Law
Experience and expertise.
Mr. Brian Meltzer has served as a director of our Group since December 1999. Subsequent to several years as Chief Economist of ICI Australia
(now Orica), Mr. Meltzer spent 25 years in investment banking. His breadth of expertise includes major property transactions, corporate advisory,
corporate finance, management buyouts, venture capital and large-scale syndications. He has held a number of Board and Board Advisory roles for
private companies in the human resources, health and wellness, aged care, software, entertainment and finance sectors, including Director of a federal
government licensed Innovation Investment Fund. In 2015 he acquired a corporate health division of an American multinational then grew it five-fold
before selling it in 2021 to the subsidiary of a Canadian multinational. Mr. Meltzer is also a Director of the Australia-Israel Chamber of Commerce and
Chairman of Independence Australia, a social enterprise.
Mr. Phillip Hains has served as Company Secretary for our Group since November 2014. Mr Hains was appointed as Chief Financial Officer in
January 2024.Mr. Hains is a Chartered Accountant operating a specialist public practice, “The CFO Solution”, now part of “Acclime” Australia. The
CFO Solution focuses on providing back office support, financial reporting and compliance systems for listed public companies. A specialist in the public
company environment, Mr. Hains has served the needs of a number of company boards and their related committees. He has over 30 years’ experience in
providing businesses with accounting, administration, compliance, and general management services.
There are no family relationships among our directors and senior executives.
46
Directors’ Interests
The relevant interest of each director, as defined by section 608 of the Corporations Act, in the share capital of the Group, as notified by the
directors to the ASX in accordance with section 205G(1) of the Corporations Act, at the date of this report is as follows:
Director
Number of
ordinary
shares
Number of
options over
ordinary
shares
Geoffrey Kempler
18,011,000
14,000,000
Lawrence Gozlan
—
7,000,000
Peter Marks
7,185,968
16,523,809
Brian Meltzer
7,469,523
16,523,809
Meeting of Directors
The number of meetings our board of directors (including committee meetings of directors) held during the year ended June 30, 2024 and the
number of meetings attended by each director were:
Board Meetings
Audit Committee
Meetings
Remuneration
Committee Meetings
Director
A
B
A
B
A
B
Geoffrey Kempler
7
7
—
—
—
—
Lawrence Gozlan
7
7
—
—
—
—
Peter Marks
7
7
4
4
2
2
Brian Meltzer
7
7
4
4
2
2
A
= Number of meetings held during the time the director held office or was a member of the committee.
B
= Number of meetings attended
—
= Not a member of the relevant committee
Board Diversity
The following matrix sets forth Board diversity information required by the Nasdaq’s rules for Alterity as a foreign private issuer
Board Diversity Matrix
Country of Principal Executive Offices:
Australia
Foreign Private Issuer
Yes
Disclosure Prohibited under Home Country Law
No
Total Number of Directors
4
Female
Male
Non-
Binary
Did Not
Disclose
Gender
Part I: Gender Identity
Directors
0
4
Part II: Demographic Background
Underrepresented Individual in Home Country Jurisdiction
LGBTQ+
Did Not Disclose Demographic Background
4
47
B.
COMPENSATION
The remuneration report is set out under the following main headings:
a)
Principles used to determine the nature and amount of remuneration
b)
Details of remuneration
c)
Share-based compensation
d)
Key management personnel disclosure
e)
Employment contracts of Directors and other key management personnel
a)
Principles used to determine the nature and amount of remuneration
Remuneration policy
Remuneration of all Executive and Non-Executive Directors, Officers and Employees of our Group is determined by the Board following
recommendation by the Remuneration Committee.
We are committed to remunerating Senior Executives and Executive Directors in a manner that is market- competitive and consistent with “Best
Practice” including the interests of Shareholders. Remuneration packages are based on fixed and variable components, determined by the Executives’
position, experience and performance, and may be satisfied via cash or equity.
In accordance with the approval of our shareholders at our 2004 annual general meeting of shareholders, the aggregate amount available per
annum for the remuneration of our non-executive directors for their services (payable in cash, ordinary shares or options) is A$1,250,000.
2024
2023
A$
A$
Base fees
Board – member (inclusive of Superannuation)
70,000
70,000
Board Chairman (exclusive of Superannuation)
100,000
100,000
Remuneration policy versus financial performance
The Group’s remuneration policy is not entirely based on our performance, but rather on industry practice.
The Group’s primary focus is research activities with a long-term objective of developing and commercializing our research and development
results.
The tables below set out summary information about our earnings and movement in shareholder wealth for the five years to June 30, 2024:
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
Interest income
268,419
16,436
2,504
20,676
17,117
Total comprehensive loss for the year
(19,123,464)
(13,806,515)
(12,847,061)
(15,309,353)
(13,456,800)
48
No dividends have been paid for the five years to June 30, 2024.
2024
2023
2022
2021
2020
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
ASX share price at start of the year
0.01
0.01
0.03
0.03
0.03
ASX share price at end of the year
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.03
0.02
Basic and diluted loss per share (cents)
(0.52)
(0.57)
(0.53)
(0.90)
(1.50)
We believe that our performance in terms of earnings will remain negative while we continue in the research and/or trial phase. Shareholder
wealth reflects this speculative and volatile market sector. This pattern is indicative of our performance over the past 5 years. Due to the stage of the
Company, remuneration has remained consistent over this period.
Performance based remuneration
The purpose of a performance bonus is to reward individual performance in line with our Group’s objectives. Consequently, performance-based
remuneration is paid to an individual where the individual’s performance clearly contributes to a successful outcome for our Group. This is regularly
measured in respect of performance against key performance indicators (“KPI’s”).
We use a variety of KPI’s to determine achievement, depending on the role of the Executive being assessed.
For details of remuneration refer to Employment Contracts of Directors and Key Management Personnel below.
b)
Details of remuneration
The following table sets forth all compensation we paid for the year ended June 30, 2024 with respect to each of our directors and executive
officers during the 2024 fiscal year.
Short Term
Benefits
Post-
Employment
Superannuation
Long
Term
Benefits
Long-
service
Termination
Equity
Base Fee
Bonus
Contribution
Leave
Benefit
Options
Total
2024
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
Directors’ remuneration
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler (2)
269,000
-
11,000
-
-
-
280,000
Mr. Brian Meltzer
63,063
-
6,937
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Peter Marks
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
472,063
-
17,937
-
-
-
490,000
Other key management personnel
Dr. David Stamler (3)
716,615
166,063
-
(13,232)
-
552,622
1,422,068
Ms. Kathryn Andrews (1)
196,334
-
20,549
6,616
10,215
(32,567)
201,147
912,949
166,063
20,549
6,616
10,215
520,055
1,623,215
Total
1,385,012
166,063
38,486
6,616
10,215
520,055
2,113,215
(1) Ms. Kathryn Andrews resigned 30 January 2024 and served out her notice period accordingly. The unvested FY21 equity options for Kathryn
Andrews were forfeited due to cessation of employment.
(2) Includes $169,000 corporate advisory fees paid to an associate entity of Mr. Geoffrey Kempler for business advisory services including investor
relations, marketing and business development.
(3) Dr. David Stamler gets paid in US dollars.
49
The following table sets forth all compensation we paid for the year ended June 30, 2023 with respect to each of our directors and executive
officers during the 2023 fiscal year.
Short Term
Benefits
Post-
Employment
Superannuation
Long
Term
Benefits
Long-
service
Termination
Equity
Base Fee
Bonus
Contribution
Leave
Benefit
Options
Total
2023
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
Directors’ remuneration
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler (2)
302,800
-
10,500
-
-
-
313,300
Mr. Brian Meltzer
63,348
-
6,652
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Peter Marks
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
506,148
-
17,152
-
-
-
523,300
Other key management personnel
Dr. David Stamler (1)(3)
731,381
194,570
-
-
-
724,047
1,649,998
Ms. Kathryn Andrews (1)
294,921
-
25,292
7,215
-
40,128
367,556
1,026,302
194,570
25,292
7,215
-
764,175
2,017,554
Total
1,532,450
194,570
42,444
7,215
-
764,175
2,540,854
(1) Base Fee includes movements in the annual leave provision for Ms. Kathryn Andrews and Dr. David Stamler in accordance with their employment
contracts.
(2) Includes A$202,800 in corporate advisory fees paid to an associated entity of Mr. Geoffrey Kempler for business advisory services including
investor relations, marketing and business development.
(3) Includes A$194,570 performance bonus, in accordance with his employment contract based on the achievement of individual and corporate goals
covering clinical, research and finance for the 2023 calendar year.
Performance income as a proportion of total remuneration
All executives are eligible to receive incentives as determined by the Board from time to time. Their performance payments are based on a set
monetary value, set number of shares or options or as a portion of base salary. Therefore, there is no fixed proportion between incentive and non-
incentive remuneration.
Non-Executive Directors are not entitled to receive bonuses and/or incentives. In the previous year, the Directors have received equity as part of
their total remuneration. Employees have received equity as recommended by the Remuneration Committee.
50
Fixed remuneration
STI
LTI
2024
2023
2024
2023
2024
2023
%
%
%
%
%
%
Directors
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
100
100
-
-
-
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
100
100
-
-
-
-
Mr. Peter Marks
100
100
-
-
-
-
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
100
100
-
-
-
-
Other key management personnel
-
Dr. David Stamler
49
44
12
12
39
44
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
100
89
-
-
-
11
Long-term incentive (“LTI”) related to remuneration were provided in the form of share-based payments.
Short-term incentives (“STI”) related to remuneration were provided in the form of cash bonus.
c)
Share-based compensation
We have an Employee and Consultant Plan designed to reward Executives, Employees and/or Consultants for their contributions. Due to our
United States presence, a United States plan, and an Australian plan were also developed. At June 30, 2024, equity had been issued to four (4) Directors,
one (1) Key Management Personnel, nine (9) employees and five (5) consultants under the 2004 ASX Plan and 2018 ADS Plan which is described on
page 59.
The term and conditions of each grant of options affecting Directors and Key Management Personnel remuneration in this reporting period are as
follows:
Grant date
Date vested and
exercisable
Expiry date
Exercise
price
Vested
Value per
option at
grant
date
September 18, 2020
September 18, 2020
September 17, 2025
$
0.09
Yes
$
0.03
January 7, 2021
January 6, 2023 onwards
January 6, 2026
$
0.03
Partially
$
0.03
July 31, 2021
July 31, 2021
July 31, 2024
$
0.07
Yes
$
0.03
November 29, 2021
November 29, 2022 onwards
November 29, 2026
$
0.02
Partially
$
0.02
November 29, 2021
November 29, 2022 onwards
November 29, 2026
$
0.04
Partially
$
0.02
December 21, 2023
December 21, 2023
December 19, 2026
$
0.01
Yes
$
0.005
March 13, 2024
March 13, 2024 onwards
March 13, 2029
$
0.004
Partially
$
0.004
March 13, 2024
March 13, 2024 onwards
March 13, 2029
$
0.005
Partially
$
0.004
March 21, 2024
March 21, 2024 onwards
March 21, 2029
$
0.003
Partially
$
0.004
Options granted under the plan carry no dividend or voting rights.
When exercisable, each option is convertible into one ordinary share as soon as practical after the receipt by us of the completed exercise form
and full payment of such exercise price.
The exercise price of options will be equal to or less than the weighted average price at which our shares are traded on the Australian Securities
Exchange during the 5 days up to and including the grant date or such other exercise price that the Remuneration Committee determines to be appropriate
under the circumstances.
The plan rules contain a restriction on removing the ‘at risk’ aspect of the instruments granted to executives. Plan participants may not enter any
transaction designed to remove the ‘at risk’ aspect of an instrument before it vests.
As of June 30, 2024, Dr. David Stamler was issued with 120,000,000 options over ordinary shares, there were no options over ordinary shares
issued as remuneration to any other key management personnel of our Group during the current financial year (2023: nil).
No ordinary shares were issued as a result of exercise of remuneration options by Directors and Key Management Personnel of Alterity
Therapeutics Limited during the current or previous financial year.
51
d)
Key management personnel disclosure
Options and right holdings
The number of options over ordinary shares of our Group held during the financial year by each Director of Alterity Therapeutics Limited and
other Key Management Personnel of our Group, including their personally related parties, are set out below:
Share Options of the Group
Balance
July 1,
2023
No.
Granted as
Remuneration
No.
Options
Expired
No.
Other
movements
(2)
Balance
June 30,
2024
No.
Total
Vested and
Exercisable
June 30,
2024
No.
Total
Unvested
June 30,
2024
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
14,000,000
-
-
-
14,000,000
14,000,000
-
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
7,000,000
-
-
-
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
7,000,000
-
-
9,523,809
16,523,809
16,523,809
-
Mr. Peter Marks
7,000,000
-
-
9,523,809
16,523,809
16,523,809
-
Ms. Kathryn Andrews (1)
5,000,000
-
-
(5,000,000)
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler
91,392,720
120,000,000
-
9,523,809
220,916,529
104,740,244
116,176,285
131,392,720
120,000,000
-
23,571,427
274,964,147
158,787,867
116,176,285
All vested options are exercisable at the end of the year and there were 116,176,285 options unvested as of June 30, 2024.
(1) Options held by Kathryn Andrews were forfeited upon resignation on 30 January, 2024.
(2) Other movements include options acquired through participation in the placement.
Share Options of the Group
Balance
July 1,
2022
No.
Granted as
Remuneration
No.
Options
Expired
No.
Other
movements
(1)
Balance
June 30,
2023
No.
Total
Vested and
Exercisable
June 30,
2023
No.
Total
Unvested
June 30,
2023
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
19,000,000
-
-
(5,000,000)
14,000,000
14,000,000
-
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
8,250,000
-
-
(1,250,000)
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
8,250,000
-
-
(1,250,000)
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Mr. Peter Marks
8,250,000
-
-
(1,250,000)
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
5,000,000
-
-
-
5,000,000
1,250,000
3,750,000
Dr. David Stamler
91,392,720
-
-
-
91,392,720
32,368,255
59,024,465
140,142,720
-
-
(8,750,000)
131,392,720
68,618,255
62,774,465
(1) Other movements represents expired options.
52
Shares provided on exercise of remuneration options
No ordinary shares were issued to key management personnel as a result of the exercise of remuneration options during the financial year ended
June 30, 2024 and June 30, 2023.
Shareholdings
The number of our ordinary shares held during the financial year by each Director of our Group and other Key Management Personnel other
than for remuneration, including their personally related parties, are set out below:
Fully Paid Ordinary Shares of the Group
Balance
July 1,
2023
No.
Received as
Remuneration
No.
Received on
Exercise of
Options
No.
Net Change
Other
No. (1)
Balance
June 30,
2024
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
18,011,000
-
-
-
18,011,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
326,666
-
-
7,142,857
7,469,523
Mr. Peter Marks
43,111
-
-
7,142,857
7,185,968
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler
3,555,000
-
-
7,142,857
10,697,857
21,935,777
-
-
21,428,571
43,364,348
(1) Net Change Other; include options acquired through participation in the placement.
Fully Paid Ordinary Shares of the Group
Balance
July 1,
2022
No.
Received as
Remuneration
No.
Received on
Exercise of
Options
No.
Net Change
Other
No.
Balance
June 30,
2023
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
18,011,000
-
-
-
18,011,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
326,666
-
-
-
326,666
Mr. Peter Marks
43,111
-
-
-
43,111
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler (1)
-
-
-
3,555,000
3,555,000
18,380,777
-
-
3,555,000
21,935,777
(1) On-market-purchase.
Loans to key management personnel
There were no loans made to the Directors or other Key Management Personnel, including their personally related parties.
53
e)
Employment contracts of Directors and other key management personnel
The following Directors and Key Management Personnel were under contract at June 30, 2024:
Key management personnel
Duration
Notice Requirements
Termination
David Stamler
Until termination by either party.
Signed 6 January 2021.
Each party will be required to
provide 6 months’ notice of
termination unless otherwise agreed
to in writing.
Accrued entitlements including all
unreimbursed business expenses
Vested but unexercised options shall
be exercisable within 30 days after the
date of termination
Unvested options will terminate
automatically without further notice
For Good Reason, Dr. Stamler may
terminate at any time upon written
notice, with 6 months’ notice.
Payment of accrued salary, accrued
but unused vacation pay and approved
but unreimbursed expenses that are
owed to date of termination Payment
equivalent to 100% of current
annualized salary
Vested but unexercised options shall
be exercisable within 30 days after the
date of termination
Unvested options will terminate
automatically without further notice
With Cause, the Group may
terminate at any time upon written
notice
Payment limited to accrued salary,
accrued but unused vacation pay and
approved but unreimbursed expenses
that are owed to date of termination.
All options shall be canceled upon
date of termination
(End of Remuneration Report)
54
C.
BOARD PRACTICES
Introduction
Our Board of Directors is elected by and accountable to our shareholders. Our Board of Directors’ responsibilities are divided into operating
activities, financial and capital markets activities and scientific activities. The Chairman of our Board of Directors, currently Mr. Geoffrey Kempler, is
responsible for the management of the Board of Directors and its functions.
Election of Directors
Directors are elected at our annual general meeting of shareholders. Under our Constitution, the term of office of our directors are staggered,
such that at every annual general meeting of shareholders one-third, rounded down to the nearest whole number, of the directors, except a Managing
Director, must retire from office and may offer himself/herself for re-election. No director, except a Managing Director, shall retain office for a period in
excess of three years without submitting for re-election. Our Board of Directors has the power to appoint any person to be a director, either to fill a
vacancy or as an additional director (provided that the total number of directors does not exceed the maximum allowed by law), and any director so
appointed may hold office only until the next annual general meeting when he or she shall be eligible for election.
Non-Executive and Independent Directors
Australian law does not require a company to appoint a certain number of independent directors to its board of directors or audit committee.
Under the rules of the NASDAQ Stock Market, a majority of our Board of Directors must qualify as independent directors within the meaning of
the rules of the NASDAQ Stock Market, each of whom satisfies the respective “independence” requirements of the NASDAQ Stock Market Rules and
the Securities and Exchange Commission. Our Board of Directors has determined that each of Messrs. Peter Marks and Brian Meltzer qualifies as an
independent director under the NASDAQ Stock Market and the Securities and Exchange Commission. As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed
on The NASDAQ Capital Market, we are permitted to follow certain home country corporate governance practices instead of certain requirements of The
NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. This includes NASDAQ rule 5605(b)(1) requiring a majority of independent directors.
Committees of the Board of Directors
Our Board of Directors has established the following committees:
Audit Committee. The NASDAQ Stock Market rules require us to establish an audit committee comprised of at least three members, each of
whom is financially literate and satisfies the respective “independence” requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission and NASDAQ and one
of whom has accounting or related financial management expertise at senior levels within a company. As a foreign private issuer whose shares are listed
on The NASDAQ Capital Market, we are permitted to follow certain home country corporate governance practices instead of certain requirements of The
NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. This includes the Rule related to Audit Committee Composition rule 5605(c)(2)(A)): we may have an audit committee
composed of two members instead of “at least three members”.
55
Our Audit Committee assists our Board of Directors in overseeing the accounting and financial reporting processes of our company and audits of
our financial statements, including the integrity of our financial statements, compliance with legal and regulatory requirements, our independent public
accountants’ qualifications and independence, the performance of our internal audit function and independent public accountants, and such other duties as
may be directed by our Board of Directors. The Audit Committee is also required to assess risk management. The audit committee meets at least four
times per year.
Our Audit Committee currently consists of two board members, each of whom satisfies the “independence” requirements of the Securities and
Exchange Commission and the NASDAQ Market Rules. Our Audit Committee is currently composed of Messrs. Marks and Meltzer. Our Board of
Directors has determined that Mr. Meltzer meets the definition of an audit committee financial expert, as defined by rules of the Securities and Exchange
Commission.
Remuneration Committee. Our Board of Directors has established a Remuneration Committee, which is comprised solely of independent
directors, within the meaning of the NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. The Remuneration Committee is responsible for reviewing the salary, incentives and
other benefits of our executive officers and to make recommendations on such matters for approval by our Board of Directors. The Remuneration
Committee is also responsible for overseeing and advising our Board of Directors with regard to the adoption of policies that govern our compensation
programs, including share and ADS option and employee benefit plans. Additionally, the Remuneration Committee administers our share and ADS
option plans and any other employee benefit plans.
Directors’ Service Contracts
There are no arrangements or understandings between us and any of our subsidiaries, on the one hand, and any of our directors, on the other
hand, providing for benefits upon termination of their employment or service as directors of our company or any of our subsidiaries.
Indemnification of Directors and Officers
Our Constitution provides that, subject to the Australian Corporations Act, every director, secretary, manager or officer of our company or any
person employed by our company as auditor shall be indemnified out of our funds against all liability incurred by such person as a director or officer in
defending proceedings, whether civil or criminal, in which judgment is given in the persons favor or in which the person is acquitted in connection with
any application under the Australian Corporations Act in which relief is granted to the person by a Court.
Under our Constitution no director, auditor or other officer shall be liable for (i) any acts, receipts, neglect or defaults of any other director or
officer for joining in any receipt or other act for conformity; (ii) any loss or expense that may happen to us through the inefficiency or deficiency of title
to any property acquired by order of the directors or on our behalf; (iii) the inefficiency or deficiency of any security in or upon which any of our monies
shall be invested; (iv) any loss or damage arising from bankruptcy, insolvency or tortuous act of any person with whom any monies, securities or effects
shall be deposited; (v) any loss occasioned by any error of judgment, omission, default or oversight on the persons part; or (vi) any other loss damage or
misfortune whatsoever which shall happen in relation to those things unless the same shall happen through the persons own negligence, default, breach or
duty, breach of trust or dishonesty.
56
In addition, our Constitution provides that to the extent permitted by law, we may pay, or agree to pay, a premium in respect of a contract
insuring a person who is or has been an officer of our company or one of our subsidiaries against a liability:
●
incurred by the person in his or her capacity as an officer of our company or a subsidiary of our company provided that the liability does not
arise out of a conduct involving a willful breach of duty in relation to our company or a subsidiary of our company; or
●
for costs and expenses incurred by that person defending proceedings, whatever their outcome.
We maintain a directors’ and officers’ liability insurance policy. We have established a policy for the indemnification of our directors and
officers against certain liabilities incurred as a director or officer, including costs and expenses associated in successfully defending legal proceedings.
D.
EMPLOYEES
We consider our employees the most valuable asset of our company. We offer competitive compensation and comprehensive benefits to attract
and retain our employees. We believe that an engaged workforce is key to maintaining our ability to innovate.
As of June 30, 2024, we had 10 employees. Of such employees, eight persons are employed in research and development and two persons in
management and administration. Seven employees are located in Australia and three employees are located in the United States.
As of June 30, 2023, we had 11 employees. Of such employees, eight persons are employed in research and development and three persons in
management and administration. Seven employees are located in Australia and four employees are located in the United States.
As of June 30, 2022, we had 12 employees. Of such employees, nine persons are employed in research and development and three persons in
management and administration. Seven employees are located in Australia and five employees are located in the United States.
Australian and US labor laws and regulations apply to our employees accordingly. The laws concern various matters, including severance pay
rights at termination, retirement or death, length of work day and work week, minimum wage, overtime payments and insurance for work-related
accidents.
57
E.
SHARE OWNERSHIP
Beneficial Ownership of Executive Officers and Directors
The following table sets forth certain information as of September 26, 2024 regarding the beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares by each of
our directors and executive officers and by all our directors and executive officers as a group:
Name
Number of
Ordinary
Shares
Beneficially
Owned (1)
Percentage of
Ownership(2)
Geoffrey P. Kempler (3)
32,011,000
0.57%
Kathryn J.E. Andrews (4)
-
-
David A. Stamler (5)
115,438,101
2.05%
Lawrence B. Gozlan (6)
7,000,000
0.12%
Peter A. Marks (7)
23,709,777
0.42%
Brian D. Meltzer (8)
23,993,332
0.43%
All directors and executive officers as a group (6 persons)
202,152,210
3.59%
1.
Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission, and generally includes voting or
investment power with respect to securities. Ordinary shares relating to options currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the date of the
above table are deemed outstanding for computing the percentage of the person holding such securities but are not deemed outstanding for
computing the percentage of any other person. Except as indicated by footnote, and subject to community property laws where applicable, the
persons named in the table above have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares shown as beneficially owned by them.
2.
The percentages shown are based on 5,626,658,038 consisting of 5,245,658,038 ordinary shares and 381,542,720 options, issued and outstanding as
of September 26, 2024.
3.
Includes options to purchase 14,000,000 ordinary shares that are exercisable for A$0.09 each on or before September 17, 2025. Of the 18,011,000
outstanding ordinary shares, 30,000 ordinary shares are held of record by Mr. Kempler, 14,165,000 ordinary shares are held by Baywick Pty Ltd., an
Australian corporation owned by Mr. Kempler, 156,000 ordinary shares are held by Sadarajak Pty Ltd., an Australian corporation owned by Mr.
Kempler, 90,000 ordinary shares are held of record by Crystal Triangle Pty Ltd., an Australian corporation owned by Mr. Kempler and 2,970,000
ordinary shares are held of record by NRB Developments Pty Ltd., an Australian corporation in which Mr. Kempler holds a 50% interest, 600,000
ordinary shares are held of record by Sandhurst Trustees Ltd. Mr. Kempler may be deemed to be the beneficial owner of the ordinary shares held of
record by Baywick Pty Ltd., Crystal Triangle Pty Ltd., NRB Developments Pty Ltd. and Sandhurst Trustees Ltd.
4.
Kathryn Andrews resigned January 30,2024.
5.
Includes vested options to purchase 32,368,255 ordinary shares that are exercisable for A$0.03 each on or before January 6, 2026. Also includes
5,925 ADSs representing 3,555,000 ordinary shares. Includes 7,142,857 Shares and 9,523,809 options as part of the placements during the 2024 year
as well as 120,000,000 options under the 2004 ASX Plan.
6.
Includes options to purchase 7,000,000 ordinary shares that are exercisable for A$0.09 each on or before September 17, 2025.
7.
Includes options to purchase 7,000,000 ordinary shares that are exercisable for A$0.09 each on or before September 17, 2025. The 43,111
outstanding ordinary shares are held of record by Lampam Pty Ltd., an Australian corporation owned by Mr. Peter Marks. Includes 7,142,857 Shares
and 9,523,809 options as part of the placements during the 2024 year.
8.
Includes options to purchase 7,000,000 ordinary shares that are exercisable for A$0.09 each on or before September 17, 2025. The 326,666
outstanding ordinary shares are held of record by BT Panorama Investment., a superannuation fund of Mr. Meltzer. Includes 7,142,857 Shares and
9,523,809 options as part of the placements during the 2024 year.
58
Stock Option Plans
In November 2004, we adopted the 2004 Employees’, Directors’ and Consultants’ Share and Option Plan, or the 2004 ASX Plan, and the 2004
American Depository Share (ADS) Option Plan, or the 2004 ADS Plan. In November 2018 we adopted an updated ADS plan with substantially the same
terms as the 2004 ADS Plan for a new ten-year term. For the description below, the 2004 ASX Plan and 2018 ADS Plan are referred to together as the
Stock Option Plans. Under the 2004 ASX Plan we may issue ordinary shares and under the 2018 ADS Plan we may issue ADSs. We were initially
authorized to issue under the Stock Option Plans up to an aggregate 12,000,000 ordinary shares or ADSs representing 12,000,000 ordinary shares.
Pursuant to subsequent shareholder approvals, the most recent of which was in November 2022, we are entitled to issue up to an aggregate 240,000,000
ordinary shares (or ADSs representing 240,000,000 ordinary shares) under the Stock Option Plans. Any increase in such maximum number of ordinary
shares or ADSs issuable under the Stock Option Plans is subject to shareholder approval.
2004 ASX Plan. The purpose of the 2004 ASX Plan is to promote the interest of our company and the interest of the employees, directors and
consultants of our company and its subsidiaries. Under the 2004 ASX Plan, we may issue to employees, directors and consultants of our company and its
subsidiaries, from time to time, ordinary shares, either by issuance of ordinary shares or under options to purchase ordinary shares granted under the 2004
ASX Plan.
The 2004 ASX Plan is administered by the Share Plan Committee, a sub-committee of the Remuneration Committee. For the purpose of the
disclosure below, the term “Remuneration Committee” shall refer to the Remuneration Committee or Share Plan Committee, as applicable. Subject to
Board approval where required by applicable law, the Remuneration Committee has the authority, in its sole discretion, to grant options under the 2004
ASX Plan, to interpret the provisions of the 2004 ASX Plan and to prescribe, amend, and rescind rules and regulations relating to the 2004 ASX Plan or
any issue or grant thereunder as it may deem necessary or advisable, subject to any other approval if required by applicable law. All decisions made by
the Remuneration Committee pursuant to the provisions of the 2004 ASX Plan will be final, conclusive and binding on all persons.
The number of shares issued or options granted, the exercise price and option term or options granted, the vesting schedule and escrow periods
of shares issued and options granted, under the 2004 ASX Plan are determined by the Remuneration Committee, in accordance with the provisions of the
ASX Plan, and specified in an offer document from our company and accepted by the eligible person, subject to the terms of the 2004 ASX Plan. Options
granted under the 2004 ASX Plan will be unlisted and exercisable at an exercise price equal to less than market value of an ordinary share on the ASX at
the date of grant, or such other exercise price that the Remuneration Committee determines to be appropriate under the circumstances. The term of an
option granted under the 2004 ASX Plan will be determined by the Remuneration Committee; however, no option will be exercisable after the expiration
of ten years from the date of its grant. Except as otherwise provided in the 2004 ASX Plan or determined by the Remuneration Committee and set forth in
an offer document, the issuance of shares and exercise of options granted under the 2004 ASX Plan will either (i) be subject to an escrow, under which
such shares or options cannot be disposed of or exercised, respectively, within six months from the date of issue or grant (or 12 months if issued or
granted to a director); or (ii) will vest over a four year period in four equal installments, 25% at the end of each year from the date of grant. Shares issued
and options granted under the 2004 ASX Plan may be subject to other performance criteria and hurdles, as determined by the Remuneration Committee.
2018 ADS Plan. The purpose of the 2018 ADS Plan is to promote the interests of our company and non-Australian based employees, officers,
consultants, independent contractors and directors. Options granted under the 2018 ADS Plan may be incentive stock options, as provided in Section 422
of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, or non-qualified stock options. Incentive stock options may only be granted to
employees of our company and its subsidiaries (including, without limitation, officers and directors who are also employees of our company and its
subsidiaries) and may not be granted to any owner of 10% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of our company and
subsidiaries, or a 10% Holder. To the extent that the aggregate fair market value, determined on the date that an option is granted, of ADSs, with respect
to which incentive stock options are exercisable for the first time by an optionee during any calendar year exceeds U.S.$100,000, such option shall be
treated as a non-qualified stock option.
59
Under the 2018 ADS Plan, we may grant to employees, officers, consultants, independent contractors and directors of our company or any of its
subsidiaries, from time to time, options to purchase ADSs representing our ordinary shares. ADSs that are forfeited under the terms of the 2018 ADS Plan
and ADSs that are the subject to options that expire unexercised or which are otherwise surrendered by an optionee without receiving any payment or
other benefit with respect to such option may again become available for new option grants under the 2018 ADS Plan.
The 2018 ADS Plan is administered by our Share Plan Committee. Subject to Board approval where required by applicable law, the
Remuneration Committee has authority, in its sole discretion, to grant options under the 2018 ADS Plan, to interpret the provisions of the 2018 ADS Plan
and to prescribe, amend, and rescind rules and regulations relating to the 2018 ADS Plan or any options granted thereunder as it may deem necessary or
advisable, subject to any other approval if required by applicable law. All decisions made by the Remuneration Committee pursuant to the provisions of
the 2018 ADS Plan shall be final, conclusive and binding on all persons.
The type of option (incentive stock option or non-qualified stock option), exercise price, option term and vesting schedule of options granted
under the 2018 ADS Plan are determined by the Remuneration Committee, in accordance with the provisions of the ADS Plan, and specified in an option
agreement by and between our company and the optionee, subject to the terms of the 2018 ADS Plan. The exercise price per each ADS will be
determined by the Remuneration Committee at the time any option is granted, however the exercise price of an incentive stock option will not be less
than 100% of the fair market value of such ADS on the date of the grant and the price of an incentive stock option granted to a 10% Holder will not be
less than 110% of the fair market value of such ADS on the date of the grant. Options granted under the 2018 ADS Plan will not be exercisable after the
expiration of ten years from the date of grant, and in the case of an incentive stock option granted to a 10% Holder, the term of the option will be five
years from the date of grant or such shorter term as may be provided in the option agreement. The options will vest over a four-year period in four equal
installments, 25% at the end of each year from the date of grant, unless otherwise provided by the Remuneration Committee in an option agreement.
Options granted under the 2018 ADS Plan are not assignable or transferable by the grantee, other than by will or the laws of descent and
distribution, and may be exercised during the lifetime of the grantee only by the grantee or his guardian or legal representative.
A summary of the status of the Stock Option Plans as of June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022, and changes during the years ended on those dates, is
presented below:
As of June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Number
Weighted
average
exercise
price
(A$)
Number
Weighted
average
exercise
price
(A$)
Number
Weighted
average
exercise
price
(A$)
Options outstanding at the beginning of
the year
170,042,720
$
0.05
184,692,720
$
0.05
160,542,720
$
0.09
Granted
217,000,000
$
0.004
-
$
-
45,150,000
$
0.04
Exercised
-
$
-
-
$
-
-
$
-
Expired/forfeited
(2,500,000)
$
0.04
(13,150,000)
$
0.11
(21,000,000)
$
0.08
Lapsed
(2,500,000)
$
0.04
(1,500,000)
$
0.02
-
-
Options outstanding at the end of the year
381,542,720
$
0.02
170,042,720
$
0.05
184,692,720
$
0.05
Options exercisable at the end of the year
195,708,100
$
0.03
87,280,755
$
0.06
60,150,000
$
0.09
Australian Disclosure Requirements
Indemnifying directors and officers
During the financial year, we maintained an insurance policy to indemnify all current Directors and Officers against certain liabilities incurred as
a Director or Officer, including costs and expenses associated in successfully defending legal proceedings. The contract of insurance prohibits disclosure
of the nature of the liability and the amount of the premium. We have not otherwise, during or since the financial year, indemnified or agreed to
indemnify an Officer or Auditor of our Group or any related body corporate against a liability incurred as such an Officer or Auditor.
60
Share options on issue during or since the end of the financial year
During or since the end of the financial year the unissued ordinary shares of Alterity Therapeutics Limited under options were as follows:
Date of expiry
Exercise
price
(A$)
Number
under options
September 17, 2025
0.09
35,000,000
January 6, 2026
0.03
91,392,720
July 31, 2024
0.07
12,000,000
November 29, 2026
0.04
14,250,000
November 29, 2026
0.02
11,900,000
December 19, 2026
0.01
8,000,000
August 31, 2026
0.01
932,706,668
August 31, 2026
0.01
1,935,759,704
March 13, 2029
0.004
26,500,000
March 13, 2029
0.005
62,500,000
March 21, 2029
0.003
120,000,000
3,250,009,092
Shares issued as a result of the exercise of options
During the year ended June 30, 2024 none of our ordinary shares were issued as a result of the exercise of options.
Since June 30, 2024, none of our ordinary shares were issued as a result of the exercise of options.
There are no amounts unpaid on the shares issued as a result of the exercise of the options during and since the end of the current financial year.
The amount paid per share is the same as the exercise price.
Proceedings on behalf of our Group
No proceedings have been brought or intervened in on behalf of our Group with leave of the Court under section 237 of the Corporations Act
2001.
Non-audit services
We may decide to employ the auditor on assignments additional to their statutory audit duties where the auditor’s expertise and experience with
our Group are important, subject to the limitations imposed by the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002.
Auditor’s independence declaration
A copy of the auditor’s independence declaration as required under section 307C of the Corporations Act 2001 in relation to the audit for the
year ended June 30, 2024 is included in Exhibit 15.2 of this annual report on Form 20-F.
Corporate governance statement
In accordance with ASX listing Rule 4.10.3, the Group’s 2024 Corporate Governance Statements can be found on its website at
www.alteritytherapeutics.com.
Signed in accordance with a resolution of the Directors made pursuant to s298(2) of the Corporations Act 2001.
/s/ Geoffrey Kempler
Geoffrey Kempler
Chairman
Melbourne
September 26, 2024
61
F.
DISCLOSURE OF A REGISTRANT’S ACTION TO RECOVER ERRONEOUSLY AWARDED COMPENSATION.
Not applicable.
ITEM 7. MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
A.
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS
There are no shareholders known to us who own beneficially more than 5% of our ordinary shares.
Significant Changes in the Ownership of Major Shareholders
Life Biosciences, LLC reported on Schedule 13/D filed on August 26, 2022, that it was the beneficial owner of 114,560,553 Ordinary Shares
evidenced by 1,909,342 ADSs, representing approximately 4.7% of our outstanding Ordinary Shares.
Major Shareholders Voting Rights
A major shareholder would not have different voting rights.
Record Holders
As of September 16, 2024, there were 5,552 holders of record of our ordinary shares, of which 25 record holders, holding approximately 41.89%
of our ordinary shares, had registered addresses in the United States. These numbers are not representative of the number of beneficial holders of our
shares nor are they representative of where such beneficial holders reside, since many of these ordinary shares were held of record by brokers or other
nominees. The majority of trading by our U.S. investors is done by means of ADSs that are held of record by HSBC Custody Nominees Ltd., which held
41.1% of our ordinary shares.
As of August 28, 2023, there were 5,475 holders of record of our ordinary shares, of which 22 record holders, holding approximately 53.20% of
our ordinary shares, had registered addresses in the United States. These numbers are not representative of the number of beneficial holders of our shares
nor are they representative of where such beneficial holders reside, since many of these ordinary shares were held of record by brokers or other nominees.
The majority of trading by our U.S. investors is done by means of ADSs that are held of record by HSBC Custody Nominees Ltd., which held 52.86% of
our ordinary shares.
As of August 26, 2022, there were 5,590 holders of record of our ordinary shares, of which 22 record holders, holding approximately 59.09% of
our ordinary shares, had registered addresses in the United States. These numbers are not representative of the number of beneficial holders of our shares
nor are they representative of where such beneficial holders reside, since many of these ordinary shares were held of record by brokers or other nominees.
The majority of trading by our U.S. investors is done by means of ADSs that are held of record by HSBC Custody Nominees Ltd., which held 58.75% of
our ordinary shares including 6.08% holding by Life Biosciences LLC as of such date.
B.
RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
There were no other related party transactions other than those related to Director and Key Management Personnel remuneration.
C.
INTERESTS OF EXPERTS AND COUNSEL
Not applicable.
62
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL INFORMATION
A.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION
See our consolidated financial statements, including the notes thereto, in Item 18.
Legal Proceedings
We are not involved in any legal proceedings nor are we subject to any threatened litigation that is material to our business or financial
condition.
Dividend Distribution Policy
We have never paid cash dividends to our shareholders. We intend to retain future earnings for use in our business and do not anticipate paying
cash dividends on our ordinary shares in the foreseeable future. Any future dividend policy will be determined by the Board of Directors and will be
based upon various factors, including our results of operations, financial condition, current and anticipated cash needs, future prospects, contractual
restrictions and other factors as the Board of Directors may deem relevant.
B.
SIGNIFICANT CHANGES
Not applicable.
ITEM 9. THE OFFER AND LISTING
A.
OFFER AND LISTING DETAILS
Australian Securities Exchange
Our ordinary shares have traded on the ASX since our initial public offering on March 29, 2000 under the symbol “PBT”. On April 8, 2019 we
changed our name to Alterity Therapeutics Limited and our shares have traded under the symbol “ATH” since that date.
NASDAQ Capital Market
On September 5, 2002 our ADSs began trading on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the symbol “PRAN.” On April 8, 2019 we changed our
name to Alterity Therapeutics Limited and our ADSs have traded under the symbol “ATHE” since that date.
B.
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
Not applicable.
C.
MARKETS
The principal listing of our ordinary shares and listed options to purchase ordinary shares is on the ASX. As of April 5, 2002, our ADSs were
eligible to trade on the NASDAQ Capital OTC Bulletin Board in the United States and until September 5, 2002, our ADSs traded on the NASDAQ
Capital Market under the symbol “PRAN.” On April 8, 2019 we changed our name to Alterity Therapeutics Limited and our ADSs have traded under the
symbol “ATHE” since that date. We entered into a Deposit Agreement with the Bank of New York under which the Bank of New York, acting as
depositary, issues ADRs. Prior to March 24, 2016, each ADR represented ten of our ordinary shares. On March 24, 2016, we effected a ratio change so
that each ADS represented 60 ordinary shares (representing a 6-for-1 reverse split). On January 9, 2023, we effected a ratio change so that each ADS now
represents 600 ordinary shares (representing a 10-for-1 reverse split).
63
D.
SELLING SHAREHOLDERS
Not applicable.
E.
DILUTION
Not applicable.
F.
EXPENSES OF THE ISSUE
Not applicable.
ITEM 10. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
A.
SHARE CAPITAL
Not applicable.
B.
MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION
We were registered on November 11, 1997 as Prana Pty Ltd and on November 26, 1999 we converted to a public company and changed our
name to Prana Corporation Ltd. On January 1, 2000, we changed our name to Prana Biotechnology Limited. On April 8, 2019 we changed our name to
Alterity Therapeutics Limited. Our registration number is ACN 080699065.
Alterity’s Purposes and Objects
As a public company we have all the rights, powers and privileges of a natural person. Our Constitution does not specify any purposes or
objects.
The Powers of the Directors
Under the provisions of our Constitution our directors may exercise all of the powers of our company, other than those that are required by our
Constitution or the Corporations Act of Australia to be exercised at a general meeting of shareholders. A director may participate in a meeting and vote
on a proposal, arrangement or contract in which he or she is materially interested, so long as the director’s interest is declared in accordance with the
Corporations Act. The authority of our directors to enter into borrowing arrangements on our behalf is not limited, except in the same manner as any
other transaction by us.
Annual and Extraordinary Meetings
Our Board of Directors must convene an annual meeting of shareholders at least once every calendar year, within five months of our last fiscal
year-end balance sheet date. Notice of at least 28 days prior to the date of the meeting is required. An extraordinary meeting may be convened by the
board of directors, it decides or upon a demand of any directors, or of one or more shareholders holding in the aggregate at least five percent of our issued
capital. An extraordinary meeting must be called not more than 21 days after the request is made. The meeting must be held not later than two months
after the request is given.
Please refer to Exhibit 2.3 for Items 10.B.3, B.4, B.6, B.7, B.8, B.9 and B.10.
64
C.
MATERIAL CONTRACTS
We do not deem any individual contract to be a material contract which is not already discussed and filed as an exhibit or in the ordinary course
of our business.
D.
EXCHANGE CONTROLS
Australia has largely abolished exchange controls on investment transactions. The Australian dollar is freely convertible into U.S. dollars. In
addition, there are currently no specific rules or limitations regarding the export from Australia of profits, dividends, capital, or similar funds belonging to
foreign investors, except that certain payments to non-residents must be reported to the Australian Cash Transaction Reports Agency, which monitors
such transactions, and amounts on account of potential Australian tax liabilities may be required to be withheld unless a relevant taxation treaty can be
shown to apply.
The Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act 1975
Under Australian law, in certain circumstances foreign persons are prohibited from acquiring more than a limited percentage of the shares in an
Australian company without notification to or approval from the Australian Treasurer. These limitations are set forth in the Australian Foreign
Acquisitions and Takeovers Act, or the Takeovers Act.
Under the Takeovers Act, as currently in effect, any foreign person, together with associates, is prohibited from acquiring 15% or more of the
shares in any company having total assets exceeding A$266 million or more. In addition, a foreign person may not acquire shares in a company having
total assets of A$266 million or more if, as a result of that acquisition, the total holdings of all foreign persons and their associates will exceed 40% in
aggregate without the approval of the Australian Treasurer. However, for “U.S. Investors” and investors from certain other countries, a threshold of
A$1,154 million applies (except in certain circumstances) to each of the previous acquisitions. A “U.S. Investor” is defined by the Takeovers Act as a
U.S. national or a U.S. enterprise.
If the necessary approvals are not obtained, the Treasurer may make an order requiring the acquirer to dispose of the shares it has acquired
within a specified period of time. Under the current Australian foreign investment policy, however, it is unlikely that the Treasurer would make such an
order where the level of foreign ownership exceeds 40% in the ordinary course of trading, unless the Treasurer finds that the acquisition is contrary to the
national interest. The same rule applies if the total holdings of all foreign persons and their associates already exceeds 40% and a foreign person (or its
associate) acquires any further shares, including in the course of trading in the secondary market of the ADSs. At present, we do not have total assets of
A$266 million.
If the level of foreign ownership exceeds 40% at any time, we would be considered a foreign person under the Takeovers Act. In such event, we
would be required to obtain the approval of the Treasurer for our company, together with our associates, to acquire (i) more than 15% of an Australian
company or business with assets totaling over A$252 million; or (ii) any direct or indirect ownership interest in Australian residential real estate.
The percentage of foreign ownership in our company would also be included in determining the foreign ownership of any Australian company or
business in which it may choose to invest. Since we have no current plans for any such acquisitions and do not own any property, any such approvals
required to be obtained by us as a foreign person under the Takeovers Act will not affect our current or future ownership or lease of property in Australia.
Our Constitution does not contain any additional limitations on a non-resident’s right to hold or vote our securities.
Australian law requires the transfer of shares in our company to be made in writing. No stamp duty will be payable in Australia on the transfer of
ADSs.
E.
TAXATION
The following is a discussion of Australian and U.S. tax consequences material to our shareholders. To the extent that the discussion is based on
tax legislation which has not been subject to judicial or administrative interpretation, the views expressed in the discussion might not be accepted by the
tax authorities in question or by court. The discussion is not intended, and should not be construed, as legal or professional tax advice and does not
exhaust all possible tax considerations.
65
Holders of our ADSs should consult their own tax advisors as to the United States, Australian or other tax consequences of the purchase,
ownership and disposition of ADSs, including, in particular, the effect of any foreign, state or local taxes.
AUSTRALIAN TAX CONSEQUENCES
In this section we discuss the material Australian tax considerations that apply to non-Australian tax residents with respect to the acquisition,
ownership and disposal of the absolute beneficial ownership of ADSs, which are evidenced by ADRs. This discussion is based upon existing Australian
tax law as of the date of this annual report, which is subject to change, possibly retrospectively. This discussion does not address all aspects of Australian
income tax law which may be important to particular investors in light of their individual investment circumstances, such as ADSs or shares held by
investors subject to special tax rules (for example, financial institutions, insurance companies or tax exempt organisations). In addition, this summary
does not discuss any foreign or state tax considerations, other than stamp duty. Prospective investors are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the
Australian and foreign income and other tax considerations of the purchase, ownership and disposition of the ADSs or shares.
Nature of ADSs for Australian Taxation Purposes
Holders of our ADSs are treated as the owners of the underlying ordinary shares for Australian income tax and capital gains tax purposes.
Therefore, dividends paid on the underlying ordinary shares will be treated for Australian tax purposes as if they were paid directly to the owners of
ADSs, and the disposal of ADSs will be treated for Australian tax purposes as the disposal of the underlying ordinary shares. In the following analysis we
discuss the application of the Australian income tax and capital gains tax rules to non-Australian resident holders of ADSs.
Taxation of Dividends
Australia operates a dividend imputation system under which dividends may be declared to be ‘franked’ to the extent of tax paid on company
profits. Fully franked dividends are not subject to dividend withholding tax. Dividends that are not franked or are partly franked and are paid to non-
Australian resident shareholders are subject to dividend withholding tax, but only to the extent the dividends are not franked.
Unfranked dividends paid to a non-resident shareholder are subject to withholding tax at 30%, unless the shareholder is a resident of a country
with which Australia has a double taxation agreement. In accordance with the provisions of the Double Taxation Convention between Australia and the
United States., the maximum rate of Australian tax on unfranked dividends to which a resident of the United States is beneficially entitled is 15%, where
the U.S. resident holds less than 10% of the voting rights in our company, or 5% where the U.S. resident holds 10% or more of the voting rights in our
company. The Double Taxation Convention between Australia and the United States does not apply to limit the tax rate on dividends where the ADSs
are effectively connected to a permanent establishment or a fixed base carried on by the owner of the ADSs in Australia through which the shareholder
carries on business or provides independent personal services, respectively.
66
Tax on Sales or other Dispositions of Shares - Capital Gains Tax
Australian capital gains derived by non-Australian residents in respect of the disposal of capital assets that are not taxable Australian property
will be disregarded. Non-Australian resident shareholders will not be subject to Australian capital gains tax on the capital gain made on a disposal of our
shares, unless they, together with associates, hold 10% or more of our issued capital, tested either at the time of disposal or over any continuous 12 month
period in the 24 months prior to disposal, and the value of our shares at the time of disposal are wholly or principally attributable to Australian real
property assets.
Australian capital gains tax applies to net capital gains at a taxpayer’s marginal tax rate. Previously, certain shareholders, such as individuals
were entitled to a discount of 50% for capital gains on shares held for greater than 12 months. However, as part of the 2012-2013 Federal Budget
measures, the Australian Government announced changes to the application of the CGT discount for foreign resident individuals on taxable Australian
assets, including shares. These changes became effective on June 29, 2013.
The effect of the change is to:
●
Retain access to the full CGT discount for discount capital gains of foreign resident individuals in respect of the increase in the value of a
CGT asset that occurred before May 9, 2013; and
●
Remove the CGT discount for discount capital gains for foreign resident individuals that arise after May 8, 2013.
Foreign residents will still have access to a discount on capital gains accrued prior to May 8, 2013 provided they choose to obtain a market
valuation for their assets as of that date.
Net capital gains are calculated after reduction for capital losses, which may only be offset against capital gains.
Tax on Sales or other Dispositions of Shares - Shareholders Holding Shares on Revenue Account
Some non-Australian resident shareholders may hold shares on revenue rather than on capital account, for example, share traders. These
shareholders may have the gains made on the sale or other disposal of the shares included in their assessable income under the ordinary income
provisions of the income tax law, if the gains are sourced in Australia.
Non-Australian resident shareholders assessable under these ordinary income provisions in respect of gains made on shares held on revenue
account would be assessed for such gains at the Australian tax rates for non-Australian residents, which start at a marginal rate of 32.5% for non-
Australian resident individuals. Some relief from the Australian income tax may be available to such non-Australian resident shareholders under the
Double Taxation Convention between the United States and Australia, for example, because the shareholder does not have a permanent establishment in
Australia.
To the extent an amount would be included in a non-Australian resident shareholder’s assessable income under both the capital gains tax
provisions and the ordinary income provisions, the capital gain amount would generally be reduced, so that the shareholder would not be subject to
double tax on any part of the income gain or capital gain.
Dual Residency
If a shareholder were a resident of both Australia and the United States under those countries’ domestic taxation laws, that shareholder may be
subject to tax as an Australian resident. If, however, the shareholder is determined to be a U.S. resident for the purposes of the Double Taxation
Convention between the United States and Australia, the Australian tax applicable would be limited by the Double Taxation Convention. Shareholders
should obtain specialist taxation advice in these circumstances.
Stamp Duty
A transfer of shares of a company listed on the ASX is not subject to Australian stamp duty except in some circumstances where one person, or
associated persons, acquires 90% or more of the shares.
67
Australian Death Duty
Australia does not have estate or death duties. No capital gains tax liability is realised upon the inheritance of a deceased person’s shares. The
disposal of inherited shares by beneficiaries, may, however, give rise to a capital gains tax liability.
Goods and Services Tax
The issue or transfer of shares will not incur Australian goods and services.
UNITED STATES FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES
The following is a summary of certain material U.S. federal income tax consequences that generally apply to U.S. Holders (as defined below)
who hold ADSs as capital assets. This summary is based on the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, Treasury regulations
promulgated thereunder, judicial and administrative interpretations thereof, and the bilateral taxation convention between Australia and the United States,
or the Tax Treaty, all as in effect on the date hereof and all of which are subject to change either prospectively or retroactively. This summary does not
discuss all the tax consequences that may be relevant to an investment in ADSs by a U.S. Holder in light of such holder’s particular circumstances or to
U.S. Holders subject to special rules, including broker-dealers, financial institutions, certain insurance companies, investors liable for alternative
minimum tax, tax-exempt organisations, regulated investment companies, non-resident aliens of the U.S. or taxpayers whose functional currency is not
the U.S. dollar, persons who hold the ADSs through partnerships or other pass-through entities, persons who acquired their ADSs through the exercise or
cancellation of any employee stock options or otherwise as compensation for their services, investors that actually or constructively own 10% or more of
our shares by vote or value, investors holding ADSs as part of a straddle or appreciated financial position or as part of a hedging or conversion
transaction , and persons required to accelerate the recognition of any item of income with respect to the ADSs as a result of such income being
recognized on an applicable financial statement.
If a partnership or an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes owns ADSs, the U.S. federal income tax treatment of a
partner in such a partnership will generally depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. A partnership that owns ADSs and
the partners in such partnership should consult their own tax advisors about the U.S. federal income tax consequences of holding and disposing of ADSs.
This summary does not address the effect of any U.S. federal taxation other than U.S. federal income taxation. In addition, this summary does
not include any discussion of U.S. federal estate and gift tax, state, local or foreign taxation. You are urged to consult your tax advisors regarding the
foreign and U.S. federal, state and local tax considerations of an investment in ADSs.
For purposes of this summary, the term “U.S. Holder” means an individual who is a citizen or, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, a resident
of the United States, a corporation or other entity taxable as a corporation created or organized in or under the laws of the United States or any political
subdivision thereof, an estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source, or a trust if (a) a court within the United States
is able to exercise primary supervision over administration of the trust, and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all substantial
decisions of the trust or (b) it has a valid election in effect under applicable U.S. Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.
For purposes of the discussion below, it is assumed that the representations contained in the deposit agreement governing the ADSs are
true and that the obligations in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be complied with in accordance with their terms.
68
Taxation of Dividends
For U.S. federal income tax purposes, U.S. Holders of ADSs will be treated as owning the underlying ordinary shares represented by the ADSs
held by them. Subject to the passive foreign investment company, or PFIC, rules discussed below, the gross amount of any distributions received with
respect to the underlying ordinary shares represented by the ADSs, including the amount of any Australian taxes withheld therefrom, will constitute
dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes, to the extent of our current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal
income tax principles. You will be required to include this amount of dividends in gross income as ordinary income. Distributions in excess of our
earnings and profits will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of your tax basis in the ADSs. Any amount in excess of your tax basis
will be treated as gain from the sale of ADSs. See “Disposition of ADSs” below for the discussion on the taxation of capital gains. Dividends will not
qualify for the dividends-received deduction generally available to corporations under Section 243 of the Code.
Dividends that we pay in Australian dollars, including the amount of any Australian taxes withheld therefrom, will be included in your income in
a U.S. dollar amount calculated by reference to the exchange rate in effect on the day such dividends are received. A U.S. Holder who receives payment
in Australian dollars and converts Australian dollars into U.S. dollars at an exchange rate other than the rate in effect on such day will likely have a
foreign currency exchange gain or loss, which would be treated as U.S.-source ordinary income or loss.
Subject to complex limitations, any Australian withholding tax imposed on our dividends will be a foreign income tax eligible for credit against
a U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability (or, alternatively, for deduction against income in determining such tax liability). The limitations set
forth in the Code include computational rules under which foreign tax credits allowable with respect to specific classes of income cannot exceed the U.S.
federal income taxes otherwise payable with respect to each such class of income. Dividends generally will be treated as foreign-source passive category
income or general category income for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes, depending upon the holder’s circumstances. A U.S. Holder will be denied a
foreign tax credit with respect to Australian income tax withheld from dividends received with respect to the underlying ordinary shares represented by
the ADSs to the extent such U.S. Holder has not held the ADSs for at least 16 days of the 31-day period beginning on the date that is 15 days before the
ex-dividend date or to the extent such U.S. Holder is under an obligation to make related payments with respect to substantially similar or related
property. Any days during which a U.S. Holder has substantially diminished its risk of loss on the ADSs are not counted toward meeting the 16-day
holding period required by the statute. The rules relating to the determination of the foreign tax credit are complex. You should consult with your own tax
advisors to determine whether and to what extent you would be entitled to this credit.
Subject to certain limitations, “qualified dividend income” received by a non-corporate U.S. Holder will be subject to tax at a reduced maximum
tax rate of 20 percent. Distributions taxable as dividends generally qualify for the 20 percent rate provided that either: (i) the issuer is entitled to benefits
under the Tax Treaty or (ii) the ADSs are readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States and certain other requirements are met.
We believe that we are entitled to benefits under the Tax Treaty and that the ADSs currently are readily tradable on an established securities market in the
United States. However, no assurance can be given that the ADSs will remain readily tradable. Furthermore, the reduced rate does not apply to dividends
received from PFICs. The amount of foreign tax credit is limited in the case of foreign qualified dividend income. U.S. Holders of ADSs should consult
their own tax advisors regarding the effect of these rules in their particular circumstances.
Disposition of ADSs
If you sell or otherwise dispose of ADSs, you will recognize gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes in an amount equal to the
difference between the amount realized on the sale or other disposition and your adjusted tax basis in the ADSs. Subject to the PFIC rules discussed
below, such gain or loss generally will be capital gain or loss and will be long-term capital gain or loss if you have held the ADSs for more than one year
at the time of the sale or other disposition. In general, any gain that you recognize on the sale or other disposition of ADSs will be U.S.-source for
purposes of the foreign tax credit limitation; losses will generally be allocated against U.S.-source income. Deduction of capital losses is subject to certain
limitations under the Code.
69
In the case of a cash basis U.S. Holder who receives Australian dollars in connection with the sale or disposition of ADSs, the amount realized
will be based on the U.S. dollar value of the Australian dollars received with respect to the ADSs as determined on the settlement date of such exchange.
A U.S. Holder who receives payment in Australian dollars and converts them into U.S. dollars at a conversion rate other than the rate in effect on the
settlement date may have a foreign currency exchange gain or loss that would be treated as ordinary income or loss.
An accrual basis U.S. Holder may elect the same treatment of foreign currency gain or loss required of cash basis taxpayers with respect to a sale
or disposition of ADSs, provided that the election is applied consistently from year to year. Such election may not be changed without the consent of the
Internal Revenue Service, or IRS. In the event that an accrual basis U.S. Holder does not elect to be treated as a cash basis taxpayer (pursuant to the
Treasury regulations applicable to foreign currency transactions), such U.S. Holder may have a foreign currency gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax
purposes because of differences between the U.S. dollar value of the Australian dollars received prevailing on the trade date and the settlement date. Any
such currency gain or loss would be treated as ordinary income or loss and would be in addition to gain or loss, if any, recognised by such U.S. Holder on
the sale or other disposition of such ADSs.
Passive Foreign Investment Companies
We are likely a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes for some U.S. Holders of our ADSs and a controlled foreign corporation (CFC) to
other U.S Holders of our ADSs. Our treatment as a PFIC could result in a reduction in the after-tax return to those U.S. Holders of our ADSs and may
affect the value of the securities.
For U.S. federal income tax purposes, we will be classified as a PFIC for any taxable year in which either (i) 75% or more of our gross income is
passive income, or (ii) at least 50% of the average value of all of our assets for the taxable year produce or are held for the production of passive income.
For this purpose, cash is considered to be an asset that produces passive income. Passive income generally includes dividends, interest, royalties, rents,
annuities and the excess of gains over losses from the disposition of assets that produce passive income. As a result of our substantial cash position and
the decline in the value of our stock, we believe that we became a PFIC during the taxable year ended June 30, 2005. We believe that we continued to be
classified as a PFIC during the taxable year ended June 30, 2022 for some U.S Holders of our ADSs and may continue to be a PFIC for each of the
subsequent fiscal years.
If we are a PFIC with respect to you, our dividends (if any are paid) will not qualify for the reduced maximum tax rate, discussed above, and,
unless you timely elect to “mark-to-market” your ADSs, as described below:
●
you will be required to allocate “excess distributions” or gain recognised upon the disposition of ADRs ratably over your holding period for
the ADSs. An “excess distribution” is the amount by which distributions during a taxable year in respect of an ADS exceed 125% of the
average annual distributions during the three preceding taxable years (or, if shorter, your holding period for the ADSs).
●
the amount allocated to each year during which we are considered a PFIC, other than the year of the distribution or disposition, will be
subject to tax at the highest individual or corporate tax rate, as the case may be, in effect for that year and an interest charge will be imposed
with respect to the resulting tax liability allocated to each such year,
●
the amount allocated to the current taxable year and any taxable year before we became a PFIC will be taxable as ordinary income in the
current year, and
●
you will be required to file an annual return on IRS Form 8621.
The PFIC provisions discussed above apply to U.S. persons who directly or indirectly hold stock in a PFIC.
Generally, a U.S. person is considered an indirect shareholder of a PFIC if it is:
●
a direct or indirect owner of a pass-through entity, including a trust or estate, that is a direct or indirect shareholder of a PFIC,
●
a shareholder of a PFIC that is a shareholder of another PFIC, or
●
a 50%-or-more shareholder of a foreign corporation that is not a PFIC and that directly or indirectly owns stock of a PFIC.
70
An indirect shareholder may be taxed on a distribution paid to the direct owner of the PFIC and on a disposition of the stock indirectly owned.
Indirect shareholders are strongly urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the application of these rules.
If we cease to be a PFIC in a future year, a U.S. Holder may avoid the continued application of the tax treatment described above by electing to
be treated as if it sold its ADSs on the last day of the last taxable year in which we were a PFIC. Any gain would be recognised and subject to tax under
the rules described above and any loss would not be recognised. A U.S. Holder’s basis in its ADSs would be increased by the amount of gain, if any,
recognised on the sale. Solely for purposes of the PFIC rules, a U.S. Holder would be required to treat its holding period for its ADSs as beginning on the
day following the last day of the last taxable year in which we were a PFIC.
If the ADSs are considered “marketable stock” and if you elect to “mark-to-market” your ADSs, you would not be subject to the rules described
above. Instead, you will generally include in income any excess of the fair market value of the ADSs at the close of each tax year over your adjusted basis
in the ADSs. If the fair market value of the ADSs has depreciated below your adjusted basis at the close of the tax year, you may generally deduct the
excess of the adjusted basis of the ADSs over its fair market value at that time. However, such deductions generally would be limited to the net mark-to-
market gains, if any, that you included in income with respect to such ADSs in prior years. Income recognised and deductions allowed under the mark-to-
market provisions, as well as any gain or loss on the disposition of ADSs with respect to which the mark-to-market election is made, are treated as
ordinary income or loss (except that loss is treated as capital loss to the extent the loss exceeds the net mark-to-market gains, if any, that a U.S. Holder
included in income with respect to such ADSs in prior years). However, gain or loss from the disposition of ADSs (as to which a “mark-to-market”
election was made) in a year in which we are no longer a PFIC will be capital gain or loss. Our ADSs should be considered “marketable stock” if they
traded at least 15 days during each calendar quarter of the relevant calendar year in more than de minimis quantities.
A U.S. Holder of ADSs will not be able to avoid the tax consequences described above by electing to treat us as a qualified electing fund, or
QEF, because we do not intend to prepare the information that U.S. Holders would need to make a QEF election.
Additional Tax on Investment Income
U.S. Holders that are individuals, estates, or trusts and whose income exceeds certain thresholds will be subject to a 3.8% Medicare contribution
tax on net investment income, which will include dividends on and capital gains from the sale or other taxable disposition of ADSs, subject to certain
limitations and exceptions.
Backup Withholding and Information Reporting
Payments in respect of ADSs may be subject to information reporting to the IRS and to U.S. backup withholding tax at a rate equal to the fourth
lowest income tax rate applicable to individuals (which, under current law, is 24%). Backup withholding will not apply, however, if you (i) are a
corporation or come within certain exempt categories and demonstrate the fact when so required or (ii) furnish a correct taxpayer identification number
and make any other required certification.
Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be credited against a U.S. Holder’s U.S.
tax liability. A U.S. Holder may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules by filing the appropriate claim for
refund with the IRS, which is generally an annual income tax return.
U.S. individuals who hold certain specified foreign financial assets, including stock in a foreign corporation, with values in excess of certain
thresholds are required to file IRS Form 8938 with their U.S. federal income tax return. Such form requires disclosure of information concerning such
foreign assets, including their value. Failure to file the form when required is subject to penalties. An exemption from reporting applies to foreign assets
held through a U.S. financial institution, generally including a non-U.S. branch or subsidiary of a U.S. institution and a U.S. branch of a non-U.S.
institution. Investors are encouraged to consult with their own tax advisors regarding the possible application of this disclosure requirement to their
investment in our ADSs.
71
F.
DIVIDENDS AND PAYING AGENTS
Not applicable.
G.
STATEMENT BY EXPERTS
Not applicable.
H.
DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY
We are subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, as applicable to “foreign private issuers” as defined in Rule 3b-4 thereunder.
As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from certain provisions of the Exchange Act. Accordingly, our proxy solicitations are not subject to the
disclosure and procedural requirements of Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act, transactions in our equity securities by our officers and directors are
exempt from reporting and the “short-swing” profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act. In addition, we are not required to
file periodic reports and financial statements as frequently or as promptly as U.S. companies whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act.
However, we file with the Securities and Exchange Commission an annual report on Form 20-F containing financial statements that have been examined
and reported on, with an opinion expressed by, an independent registered public accounting firm, and we submit reports to the Securities and Exchange
Commission on Form 6-K containing (among other things) press releases and unaudited financial information for the first six months of each fiscal year.
We post our annual report on Form 20-F on our website (www.alteritytherapeutics.com) promptly following the filing of our annual report with the
Securities and Exchange Commission. The information on our website is not incorporated by reference into this annual report.
The documents concerning our company referred to in this annual report may also be inspected at our registered office located at Level 3, 62
Lygon Street, Carlton, Victoria, 3053, Australia.
I.
SUBSIDIARY INFORMATION
Not applicable.
J.
Annual Report to Security Holders.
Not applicable.
ITEM 11. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
We invest our excess cash and cash equivalents in interest-bearing accounts and term deposits with banks in Australia. Our management believes
that the financial institutions that hold our investments are financially sound and accordingly, minimal credit risk exists with respect to these investments.
Certain of our cash equivalents are subject to interest rate risk. Due to the short duration and conservative nature of these instruments, we do not believe
that we have a material exposure to interest rate risk. Our major market risk is changes in foreign exchange rates as we had approximately A$225,722,
A$15,473,231, and A$29,361,393 cash held in U.S. dollars, which is our major foreign currency, as of June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022, respectively. A
hypothetical 13% adverse movement, based on average of highest and lowest exchange rate during the year, would reduce the cash balance at the end of
each year by approximately A$19,995.
We conduct our activities in mostly in Australia and the USA. We are required to make certain payments in U.S. dollars and other currencies,
however we believe an adverse movement in end-of-period exchange rates would not have a material impact on our operating results. In the twelve
months ended June 30, 2024, the Australian dollar depreciated against the U.S. dollar by 0.35%. In the financial years 2023 and 2022, the Australian
dollar depreciated by 3.6% and appreciated by 8.19% against the U.S. dollar, respectively. A hypothetical 13% adverse movement in the U.S. dollar
would increase the cost of our foreign currency payables by approximately A$44,984.
We do not currently utilize derivative financial instruments or other financial instruments subject to market risk.
72
ITEM 12. DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES
Fees and Charges Payable by ADS Holders
The table below summarizes the fees and charges that a holder of our ADSs may have to pay, directly or indirectly, to our depositary, The Bank
of New York Mellon, or BNYM, pursuant to the Deposit Agreement, which was filed as Exhibit 2.1 to our Registration Statement on Form F-6 filed with
the SEC on December 21, 2007, and the types of services and the amount of the fees or charges paid for such services. The disclosure under this heading
“Fees and Charges Payable by ADS Holders” is subject to and qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of the Deposit Agreement. The holder
of an ADS may have to pay the following fees and charges to BNYM in connection with ownership of the ADS:
Persons Depositing or Withdrawing Shares Must Pay:
For:
●U.S.$3.00 (or less) per 100 ADSs (or portion of 100 ADSs)
●Issuance of ADSs, including issuances resulting from a distribution
of shares or rights or other property
●Cancellation of ADSs for the purpose of withdrawal, including if the
deposit agreement terminates
●U.S.$0.03 (or less) per ADS
●Any cash distribution to you
●A fee equivalent to the fee that would be payable if securities distributed to
you had been shares and the shares had been deposited for issuance of ADSs
●Distribution of securities distributed to holders of deposited
securities which are distributed by the depositary to ADS holders
●U.S.$1.50 (or less) per ADS
●Transfers, combination and split-up of ADSs
●Expenses of the depositary
●Cable, telex and facsimile transmissions (when expressly provided in
the deposit agreement)
●Converting foreign currency to U.S. dollars
●Taxes and other governmental charges the depositary or the custodian have
to pay on any ADS or share underlying an ADS, for example, stock transfer
taxes, stamp duty or withholding taxes
●As necessary
●Any charges incurred by the depositary or its agents for servicing the
deposited securities
●As necessary
The depositary collects its fees for delivery and surrender of ADSs directly from investors depositing shares or surrendering ADSs for the
purpose of withdrawal or from intermediaries acting for them. The depositary collects fees for making distributions to investors by deducting those fees
from the amounts distributed or by selling a portion of distributable property to pay the fees. The depositary may collect its annual fee for depositary
services by deduction from cash distributions or by directly billing investors or by charging the book-entry system accounts of participants acting for
them. The depositary may collect any of its fees by deduction from any cash distribution payable to ADS holders that are obligated to pay those fees. The
depositary may generally refuse to provide fee-attracting services until its fees for those services are paid.
From time to time, the depositary may make payments to us to reimburse and/or share revenue from the fees collected from ADS holders, or
waive fees and expenses for services provided, generally relating to costs and expenses arising out of establishment and maintenance of the ADS
program. In performing its duties under the deposit agreement, the depositary may use brokers, dealers or other service providers that are affiliates of the
depositary and that may earn or share fees or commissions.
Fees and Payments Made by the Depositary to the Company
We incurred expenses in relation to services for our annual general meeting and special general meeting of shareholders. For the year ended June
30, 2024, we paid BNYM a total of U.S.$43,498 (comprised of payments for the distribution and printing of meeting material and proxy vote tabulation).
For the year ended June 30, 2023, we paid BNYM a total of U.S.$18,066 (comprised of payments for the distribution and printing of meeting material
and proxy vote tabulation).
73
PART II
ITEM 13. DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES
Not applicable.
ITEM 14. MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
Not applicable.
ITEM 15. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
We maintain disclosure controls and procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we
file or submit under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) is recorded, processed, summarised and reported within the
time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms, and that such information required to be disclosed by us in the
reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to our chief executive officer and chief financial officer to allow
timely decisions regarding required disclosure. Our management, including our chief executive officer and chief financial officer, conducted an
evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures, as defined under Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e), as of the end of the period covered
by this Annual Report on Form 20-F. Based upon that evaluation, our chief executive officer and chief financial officer concluded that, as of June 30,
2024, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective.
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Internal control over
financial reporting is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) or 15d-15(f) promulgated under the Exchange Act as a process designed by, or under the supervision of,
the company’s principal executive and principal financial officers and effected by the company’s board of directors, management and other personnel, to
provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and includes those policies and procedures that:
●
pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of
the company;
●
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with
authorizations of management and directors of the company; and
●
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use of disposition of the company’s
assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Projections of any
evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the
degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Our management assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of June 30, 2024. In making this assessment, our
management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organisations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control-
Integrated Framework (2013). Based on that assessment, our management concluded that as of June 30, 2024, our internal control over financial
reporting is effective.
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by this annual report on Form
20-F that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
74
ITEM 16. RESERVED
ITEM 16A. AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT
Our Board of Directors has determined that Mr. Brian Meltzer, an independent director, meets the definition of an audit committee financial
expert, as defined by rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission. For a brief listing of Mr. Meltzer’s relevant experience, see Item 6.A. “Directors,
Senior Management and Employees - Directors and Senior Management.”
ITEM 16B. CODE OF ETHICS
We have adopted a code of ethics that applies to all senior financial officers of our company, including our chief executive officer, chief
financial officer, chief accounting officer or controller, or persons performing similar functions. The code of ethics is publicly available on our website at
www.alteritytherapeutics.com. Written copies are available upon request. If we make any substantive amendment to the code of ethics or grant any
waivers, including any implicit waiver, from a provision of the codes of ethics, we will disclose the nature of such amendment or waiver on our website.
ITEM 16C. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
Fees Paid to Independent Public Accountants
The following table sets forth, for each of the years indicated, the fees billed by PricewaterhouseCoopers, which has served as our principal
independent registered public accounting firm since November 30, 2006.
Year Ended June 30,
Services Rendered
2024
2023
Audit and review of financial statements (1)
A$
248,200
A$
246,400
Other audit services
A$
95,500
A$
52,000
Total
A$
343,700
A$
298,400
(1) Audit fees consist of services that would normally be provided in connection with statutory and regulatory filings or engagements, including services
that generally only the independent accountant can reasonably provide.
Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures
Our Audit Committee has adopted policies and procedures for the pre-approval of audit and non-audit services rendered by our independent
registered public accounting firm. Pre-approval of an audit or non-audit service may be given as a general pre-approval, as part of the audit committee’s
approval of the scope of the engagement of our independent registered public accounting firm, or on an individual basis. Any proposed services
exceeding general pre-approved levels also requires specific pre-approval by our audit committee. The policy prohibits retention of the independent
registered public accounting firm to perform the prohibited non-audit functions defined in Section 201 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act or the rules of the
Securities and Exchange Commission, and also requires the audit committee to consider whether proposed services are compatible with the independence
of the registered public accounting firm. All of the fees described above were pre-approved by our Audit Committee.
ITEM 16D. EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES
Not applicable.
ITEM 16E. PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS
Issuer Purchase of Equity Securities
Neither we, nor any affiliated purchaser of our company, has purchased any of our securities during the year ended June 30, 2024.
75
ITEM 16F. CHANGES IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT
None.
ITEM 16G. CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Under NASDAQ Stock Market Rule 5615(a)(3), foreign private issuers, such as our company, are permitted to follow certain home country
(Australian) corporate governance practices instead of certain provisions of the NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. A foreign private issuer that elects to
follow a home country practice instead of any NASDAQ rule must submit to NASDAQ, in advance, a written statement from an independent counsel in
such issuer’s home country certifying that the issuer’s practices are not prohibited by the home country’s laws. We have submitted a notice to NASDAQ
informing them of that we elect to follow home country practice instead of the following NASDAQ rules:
●
the Rule related to Audit Committee Composition rule 5605(c)(2)(A)): we may have an audit committee composed of two members instead
of “at least three members”. We may not follow NASDAQ rules regarding independence of such members (as long as comply Rule 10A-3
(b)(1) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, subject to the exemptions provided in rule 10A-3(c)), and we may not have a financially
sophisticated member as defined.
●
the Rule requiring maintaining a majority of independent directors (Rule 5605(b)(1))
●
the Rule requiring that our independent directors have regularly scheduled meetings at which only independent directors are present (Rule
56505(b)(2)
●
the Rule regarding independent director oversight of director nominations process for directors (Rule 5605(e)
●
the Rule regarding independent director oversight of executive officer compensation (Rule 5605(d)
●
the requirement to obtain shareholder approval for the establishment or amendment of certain equity based compensation plans (Rule 5635
(c), an issuance that will result in a change of control of the company (Rule 5635(b), certain transactions other than a public offering
involving issuances of a 20% or more interest in the company (Rule 5635(d) and certain acquisitions of the stock or assets of another
company (Rule 5635(a)).
ITEM 16H. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE
Not applicable.
ITEM 16I. DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICATIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS
Not applicable.
.
ITEM 16J. INSIDER TRADING POLICIES
Our board of directors has adopted a securities trading policy which outlines when directors, senior management and other employees may deal
in our securities and procedures to reduce the risk of insider trading .A copy of the insider trading policy is attached as Exhibit 11.1 to this annual report.
ITEM 16K. CYBERSECURITY
Cybersecurity Risk Management and Strategy
Cybersecurity risk management is an integral part of our risk management framework. Our approach aligns with industry standards, including
the National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) Cybersecurity Framework (CSF) , to effectively manage cybersecurity threats and incidents,
including those related to third-party applications and services.
Our framework includes:
●
Assessing the severity of cybersecurity threats
●
Identifying the sources of cybersecurity threats
●
Implementing countermeasures and mitigation strategies
●
Reporting material cybersecurity threats and incidents to management
76
Processes for Assessing, Identifying, and Managing Material Risks from Cybersecurity Threats
(i)
Integration into Overall Risk Management:
Cybersecurity risk management is integrated into our broader risk management system. Regular risk assessments and business impact analyses
are conducted to identify critical systems, applications, and data, as well as potential disruptions and their consequences. The Information Security
Officer (ISO) conducts these assessments, which inform the development of contingency plans including redundancy, backup and recovery, alternate site
operations, and data restoration.
(ii) Engagement & Oversight of Third Parties:
We engage third-party assessors, consultants, and experts to strengthen our cybersecurity processes. For example, we utilize third-party services
for continuous vulnerability scanning, perimeter testing, Dynamic Application Security Testing (DAST) , and penetration testing to identify and address
potential security weaknesses in our systems. Additionally, we engage expert architects to help design and maintain secure cloud infrastructures.
Our third-party engagement and oversight process includes conducting thorough due diligence, performing vendor risk assessments, and
maintaining continuous monitoring to ensure that service providers adhere to our security standards and comply with contractual obligations.
Material Effects of Cybersecurity Threats
In the past year, we did not encounter any cybersecurity threats that materially affected or are likely to materially affect our business strategy,
results of operations, or financial condition. Nonetheless, we continuously enhance our cybersecurity posture to mitigate potential material impacts. Our
risk management program outlines procedures for regular log reviews, incident detection, and remediation to ensure ongoing protection of our
information systems.
Cybersecurity Governance
Board of Directors’ Oversight
Our Board of Directors plays a critical role in overseeing cybersecurity risks as part of its broader risk oversight responsibilities. The
Information Security Officer (ISO) provides the board with updates on cybersecurity risks and incidents. Significant cybersecurity incidents are reported
to the board to ensure appropriate and timely responses.
Management’s Role in Assessing and Managing Cybersecurity Risks
(i) Management Positions and Committees:
The ISO is responsible for developing and maintaining our cybersecurity and contingency plans, coordinating risk assessments, and managing
incident responses. The ISO has extensive experience in building secure web applications for healthcare. In addition to the ISO, we engage consultants
and DevOps engineers with relevant degrees and certifications to support our cybersecurity efforts. System Owners are responsible for identifying critical
systems, assessing risks, and implementing appropriate security controls.
(ii) Processes for Information and Monitoring:
We have established comprehensive processes for continuous monitoring and information sharing. These include regular reviews of audit logs,
system activity analysis, and the deployment of Security Information and Event Management (SIEM) tools for centralized monitoring. These processes
facilitate the timely detection and response to potential security incidents.
(iii) Reporting to the Board:
The ISO regularly reports to executive management and the Board of Directors. These reports include findings from risk assessments, incident
reports, and updates on the status of ongoing security initiatives, ensuring that the board is well-informed about our cybersecurity posture.
77
PART III
ITEM 17. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Our company has elected to furnish financial statements and related information specified in Item 18.
ITEM 18. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Page
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-1
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (PricewaterhouseCoopers, Melbourne, Australia, Auditor Firm ID: 1379)
F-2
Consolidated Statements of Financial Position
F-4
Consolidated Statements of Profit or Loss and Other Comprehensive Loss
F-5
Consolidated Cash Flow Statements
F-6
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity
F-7
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-8
Australian Disclosure Requirements
All press releases, financial reports and other information are available on our website: https://alteritytherapeutics.com/
78
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Page
Number
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
F-2
Consolidated Statements of Financial Position
F-4
Consolidated Statements of Profit or Loss and Other Comprehensive Loss
F-5
Consolidated Cash Flow Statements
F-6
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity
F-7
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-8
F-1
F-2
This page is intentionally left blank
F-3
This page is intentionally left blank
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION
(in Australian dollars, except number of share)
June 30,
Notes
2024
2023
Assets
Current Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
12,638,885
15,773,783
Trade and other receivables
5
4,041,675
8,665,704
Other current assets
6
2,356,300
2,609,286
Total Current Assets
19,036,860
27,048,773
Non-Current Assets
Property and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of A$207,892 and A$181,681
respectively
32,154
61,776
Right-of-use assets net of accumulated depreciation of A$224,307 and A$278,245 respectively
13
154,729
207,087
Total Non-Current Assets
186,883
268,863
Total Assets
19,223,743
27,317,636
Liabilities
Current Liabilities
Trade and other payables
7
4,619,947
3,517,708
Provisions
8
530,699
729,202
Other current liabilities
100,000
-
Lease liabilities
13
107,131
107,177
Current tax liabilities
15,995
27,930
Total Current Liabilities
5,373,772
4,382,017
Non-Current Liabilities
Provisions
8
-
19,503
Lease liabilities
13
51,914
103,207
Total Non-Current Liabilities
51,914
122,710
Total Liabilities
5,425,686
4,504,727
Net Assets
13,798,057
22,812,909
Equity
Issued capital
10
223,152,985
213,971,323
2024: 5,245,115,318 fully paid ordinary shares
Nil options over fully paid ordinary shares
2023: 2,439,897,618 fully paid ordinary shares
Nil options over fully paid ordinary shares
Reserves
11
4,806,203
3,972,475
Accumulated deficit during the development stage
12
(214,161,131)
(195,130,889)
Total Equity
13,798,057
22,812,909
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
F-4
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
(in Australian dollars, except number of share and per share amounts)
Years ended June 30,
Notes
2024
2023
2022
Interest income
2
268,419
16,436
2,504
Other income
2
4,019,285
3,916,333
5,123,525
Intellectual property expenses
(214,304)
(285,067)
(364,665)
General and administration expenses
3
(4,762,643)
(5,056,571)
(5,513,915)
Research and development expenses
3
(18,644,047)
(13,198,583)
(14,745,776)
Other operating expenses
(5,238)
(29,404)
(1,156)
Other gains and losses
3
261,152
917,650
2,722,430)
Forfeited options from reserves
-
17,150
-
Loss before income tax expense
(19,077,376)
(13,702,056)
(12,777,053)
Income tax expense
4
(46,088)
(104,459)
(70,008)
Loss for the year
(19,123,464)
(13,806,515)
(12,847,061)
Other comprehensive loss
-
-
-
Total comprehensive loss for the year
(19,123,464)
(13,806,515)
(12,847,061)
Loss per share (basic and diluted - cents per share)
18
(0.52)
(0.57)
(0.53)
Weighted average number of ordinary shares used in computing basic and
diluted net loss per share
3,648,875,564
2,427,841,917
2,405,990,036
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
F-5
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENTS
(in Australian dollars)
Years Ended June 30,
Notes
2024
2023
2022
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
Payments to suppliers and employees
(21,393,136)
(19,943,617)
(16,875,144)
Interest received
269,075
15,798
2,755
R&D tax refund
8,583,477
-
4,126,364
Interest paid
(7,217)
(4,565)
(2,285)
Other grant received
-
-
454,120
Income tax paid
(58,023)
(103,453)
(43,084)
Net cash flows used in operating activities
14(a)
(12,605,824)
(20,035,837)
(12,337,274)
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
Payments for rental security deposits
-
(29,150)
-
Payments for purchase of plant and equipment
(5,722)
(7,311)
(89,147)
Net cash flows used in investing activities
(5,722)
(36,461)
(89,147)
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
Proceeds from issue of ordinary shares and other equity securities
10,144,682
316,675
17,176,040
Payment of share issue costs
(918,020)
(132,413)
(836,969)
Principal elements of lease payments
(10,370)
(59,922)
(34,513)
Net cash flows generated from financing activities
9,216,292
124,340
16,304,558
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
(3,395,254)
(19,947,958)
3,878,137
Opening cash and cash equivalents brought forward
15,773,783
34,806,799
28,115,516
Exchange rate adjustments on cash and cash equivalents held in foreign
currencies
260,356
914,942
2,813,146
Closing cash and cash equivalents carried forward
14(b)
12,638,885
15,773,783
34,806,799
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
F-6
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(in Australian dollars, except for number of shares)
Notes
Number of
Shares
Issued
Capital
Reserves
Accumulated
Deficit
During
Development
Stage
Total
Equity
Balance, June 30, 2021
2,084,016,678
197,447,990
2,750,884
(169,728,414)
30,470,460
Transactions with owners in their
capacity as owners:
Issuance of shares
10(b)
322,857,900
17,176,040
-
-
17,176,040
Non-cash issuance of options to directors
and employees
11(b)
-
-
1,179,577
-
1,179,577
Non-cash issuance of options to
consultants
11(b)
-
-
326,544
-
326,544
Issuance of shares in connection with
exercise of options, net of costs
10(b) & 11(b)
-
-
-
-
-
Transaction costs from issuance of shares
-
(836,969)
-
-
(836,969)
Expired options
-
-
(240,310)
240,310
-
Forfeited options of vested options
reversed to accumulated deficit
-
-
(450,777)
450,777
-
322,857,900
16,339,071
815,034
691,087
17,845,192
Net loss
-
-
-
(12,847,061)
(12,847,061)
Total comprehensive loss for the year
-
-
-
(12,847,061)
(12,847,061)
Balance, June 30, 2022
2,406,874,578
213,787,061
3,565,918
(181,884,388)
35,468,591
Transactions with owners in their
capacity as owners:
Issuance of shares
10(b)
33,023,040
316,675
-
-
316,675
Non-cash issuance of options to directors
and employees
11(b)
-
-
983,721
-
983,721
Non-cash issuance of options to
consultants
11(b)
-
-
-
-
-
Issuance of shares in connection with
exercise of options, net of costs
10(b) & 11(b)
-
-
-
-
-
Transaction costs from issuance of shares
-
(132,413)
-
-
(132,413)
Expired options
-
-
(560,014)
560,014
-
Forfeited options reversed to profit or loss
-
-
(17,150)
-
(17,150)
33,023,040
184,262
406,557
560,014
1,150,833
Net loss
-
-
-
(13,806,515)
(13,806,515)
Total comprehensive loss for the year
-
-
-
(13,806,515)
(13,806,515)
Balance, June 30, 2023
2,439,897,618
213,971,323
3,972,475
(195,130,889)
22,812,909
Transactions with owners in their
capacity as owners:
Issuance of shares
10(b)
2,798,120,281
10,050,000
10,050,000
Non-cash issuance of options to directors
and employees
11(b)
881,950
881,950
Contributions of equity/
Shares to be issued
45,000
45,000
Issuance of shares in connection with
exercise of options, net of costs
10(b) & 11(b)
7,097,419
49,020
49,682
Transaction costs from issuance of shares
(918,020)
(918,020)
Expired options
Forfeited options reversed to profit or loss
(93,222)
93,222
-
2,805,217,700
9,181,662
833,728
93,222
10,108,612
Net loss
(19,123,464)
(19,123,464)
Total comprehensive loss for the year
(19,123,464)
(19,123,464)
Balance, June 30, 2024
5,245,115,318
223,152,985
4,806,203
(214,161,131)
13,798,057
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
F-7
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Background
Alterity Therapeutics Limited and its controlled subsidiaries, Alterity Therapeutics Inc. and Alterity Therapeutics UK Limited (referred to collectively as
“Alterity” or the “Group”), is a development stage enterprise engaged in the research and development of therapeutic drugs designed to treat the
underlying cause of degeneration of the brain focusing on Alzheimer’s disease, Huntington disease, Parkinson’s disease and other neurological disorders.
Alterity Therapeutics Limited, the parent entity, was incorporated on November 11, 1997 in Melbourne, Australia and the UK and U.S. subsidiaries were
incorporated in August 2004.
Financial Reporting Framework
The financial report of Alterity Therapeutics Limited for the year ended June 30, 2024 was authorized for issue on September 26, 2024.
Alterity Therapeutics Limited is a for-profit entity for the purpose of preparing the financial statements.
The consolidated financial statements of the Group comply with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS Accounting Standards”) as issued by
the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and Australian equivalent International Financial Reporting Standards, as issued by the Australian
Accounting Standards Board.
These financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, as modified by the revaluation of financial liabilities at fair value
through profit or loss.
Accounting policies are selected and applied in a manner which ensures that the resulting financial information satisfies the concepts of relevance and
reliability, thereby ensuring that the substance of the underlying transactions or other events is reported.
The accounting policies set out below have been applied in preparing the financial statements for the year ended June 30, 2024 and the comparative
information presented in these financial statements for the years ended June 30, 2023 and 2022.
Critical accounting estimates, judgments and assumptions
Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated and are based on historical experience and other factors, including expectations of future events that
may have a financial impact on the entity and that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances.
The Group makes estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates will, by definition, seldom equal the related actual
results. The estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within
the next financial year are discussed below.
Share-based Payments
The value attributed to share options and remuneration shares issued is an estimate calculated using an appropriate mathematical formula based on an
option pricing model. The choice of models and the resultant option value require assumptions to be made in relation to the likelihood and timing of the
conversion of the options to shares and the value and volatility of the price of the underlying shares.
F-8
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
R&D Tax Incentives
The Australian Government replaced the research and development tax concession with the research and development tax incentive from July 1, 2011.
The provisions provide refundable or non-refundable tax offsets. The research and development tax incentive applies to expenditure incurred and the use
of depreciating assets in an income year commencing on or after July 1, 2011. A 43.5% refundable tax offset will be available to eligible small companies
with an annual aggregate turnover of less than $20 million. Management has assessed these activities and expenditure to determine which are likely to be
eligible under the incentive scheme. For the period to June 30, 2024 the Group has recorded an item in other income of A$4.0 million (2023: A$3.9
million, 2022: A$4.7 million) to recognize this amount which relates to this period.
Going Concern Basis
The Group is a development stage medical biotechnology company and as such expects to be utilizing sources of cash funding until its research activities
have become marketable. The Group has incurred recurring losses since inception including a net loss of $19,123,464 in the year ended 30 June 2024
(2023: $13,806,515) and a net operating cash outflow of $12,605,824 in the year ended 30 June 2024 (2023: $20,035,837). The Group expects to
continue incurring losses into the foreseeable future and will need to raise additional capital to continue the development of its planned research and
development programs. The continuing viability of the Group is subject to its ability to raise additional capital to finance the continuation of its planned
research and development programs, maintaining implemented cost containment and deferment strategies, and successfully commercializing its
initiatives. The Group intends to raise new equity funding within six months of the financial year end to enable progression of its planned research and
development programs, however there is uncertainty associated with its ability to successfully raise such funds in the time and amounts needed to meet its
requirements.
The inability to obtain funding, as and when needed, would have a negative impact on the Group’s financial condition and ability to pursue its business
strategies. If the Group is unable to obtain the required funding to operate and to develop and commercialize its product candidates, it could be forced to
delay, reduce or eliminate some or all of its research and development programs, which would adversely affect its business prospects.
As a result of these matters, there is a material uncertainty that may cast significant doubt (or raise substantial doubt as contemplated by Public Company
Accounting Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) standards) on the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and, therefore, that it may be unable to realize
its assets and discharge its liabilities in the normal course of business. These consolidated financial statements have been prepared assuming the Group
will continue as a going concern which contemplates the continuity of operations, realization of assets and the satisfaction of liabilities in the ordinary
course of business and do not include adjustments that would result if the Group were unable to continue as a going concern.
F-9
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
Use of Estimates
The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires the Group to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets,
liabilities, income and expenses and related disclosures. On an ongoing basis, the Group evaluates its significant accounting policies and estimates.
Estimates are based on historical experience and on various market-specific and other relevant assumptions that the Group believes to be reasonable
under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities. Estimates are
assessed each period and updated to reflect current information.
Development Stage – Risks and Uncertainties
As a development stage enterprise, the Group’s prospects are subject to the risks, expenses and uncertainties frequently encountered by companies which
have not yet commercialized any applications of their technology, particularly in new and evolving markets. Alterity’s operating results may fluctuate
significantly in the future as a result of a variety of factors, including capital expenditure and other costs relating to establishing, maintaining and
expanding the operations, the number and mix of potential customers, potential pricing of future products by the Group and its competitors, new
technology introduced by the Group and its competitors, delays or expense in obtaining necessary equipment, economic and social conditions in the
biotechnology industry and general economic conditions.
The Group cannot be certain that it will be able to raise any required funding or capital, on favorable terms or at all, or that it will be able to establish
corporate collaborations on acceptable terms, if at all. If the Group is unable to obtain such additional funding or capital, it may be required to reduce the
scope of its development plans.
The Group’s experience in exploiting its technology is limited and it cannot be certain that its operations will be profitable in the short-term, or at all. If
the Group fails in its efforts to establish or expand its business, the results of operations, financial condition and liquidity of the Group could be materially
adversely affected. The Group cannot be certain that it will be able to sell and deliver its technology or to obtain or retain any permits required in the
market in which it operates. Any of these factors could result in the reduction or cessation of the Group’s operations.
F-10
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
Material Accounting Policies
Accounting policies are selected and applied in a manner which ensures that the resulting financial information satisfies the concepts of relevance and
reliability, thereby ensuring that the substance of the underlying transactions or other events is reported.
The following significant accounting policies have been adopted in the preparation and presentation of the financial report.
(a) Principles of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements are prepared by combining the financial statements of all the entities that comprise the Group, being Alterity
Therapeutics Limited and its subsidiaries as defined in Accounting Standard IFRS10 (AASB 10): Consolidated Financial Statements. Consistent
accounting policies are employed in the preparation and presentation of the consolidated financial statements.
Subsidiaries are all those entities (including special purpose entities) over which the Group has control. The group controls an entity where the group is
exposed to, or has rights to, variable returns from its involvement with the entity and has the ability to affect those returns through its power to direct the
activities of the entity. The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are considered when assessing
whether the Group controls another entity.
Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Group. They are de-consolidated from the date that control ceases.
In preparing the consolidated financial statements, all inter-company balances and transactions, and unrealized profits/losses arising within the Group are
eliminated in full. Investments in subsidiaries are accounted for at cost in the individual financial statements of Alterity Therapeutics Limited.
(b) Segment Reporting
Operating segments are reported in a manner consistent with the internal reporting provided to the chief operating decision maker. The chief operating
decision maker, who is responsible for allocating resources and assessing performance of the operating segments, has been identified as the Chief
Executive Officer of Alterity Therapeutics Limited. For the current and previous reporting periods, the Group operated in one segment, being research
and development into Parkinsonian and other neurodegenerative disorders.
(c) Income Tax
Current tax
Current tax is calculated by reference to the amount of income taxes payable or recoverable in respect of the taxable profit or loss for the period. It is
calculated using tax rates and tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by reporting date. Current tax for current and prior periods is
recognised as a liability (or asset) to the extent that it is unpaid (or refundable).
Deferred tax
Deferred tax is accounted for using the liability method in respect of temporary differences arising from differences between the carrying amount of
assets and liabilities in the financial statements and the corresponding tax base of those items.
F-11
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(c) Income Tax (continued)
In principle, deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognised for all taxable temporary differences. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it
is probable that sufficient taxable amounts will be available against which deductible temporary differences or unused tax losses and tax offsets can be
utilized. However, deferred tax assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary differences giving rise to them arise from the initial recognition
of assets and liabilities (other than as a result of a business combination) which affects neither taxable income nor accounting profit or loss.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries except where the Group is able to control
the reversal of the temporary differences and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future. Deferred tax assets
arising from deductible temporary differences associated with these investments are only recognised to the extent that it is probable that there will be
sufficient taxable profits against which to utilize the benefits of the temporary differences and they are expected to reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply to the period(s) when the asset and liability giving rise to them
are realized or settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted by reporting date. The measurement of deferred
tax liabilities and assets reflects the tax consequences that would follow from the manner in which the Group expects, at the reporting date, to recover or
settle the carrying amount of its assets and liabilities.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets and liabilities and when the deferred tax
balances relate to the same taxation authority. Current tax assets and tax liabilities are offset when the entity has a legally enforceable right to offset and
intends either to settle on a net basis or to realize the asset and settle the liability simultaneously.
Current and deferred tax for the period
Current and deferred tax is recognised as an expense or income in the Statement of Profit or Loss and Other Comprehensive Income, except when it
relates to items credited or debited directly to equity, in which case the deferred tax is also recognised directly in equity, or where it arises from the initial
accounting for a business combination, in which case it is taken into account in the determination of goodwill.
The Group has significant unused tax losses and as such a significant deferred tax asset; however, the deferred tax asset has not been recognised, as it is
not probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the unused losses and unused tax credits can be utilized, given the nature of the
Group’s business (research and development) and its history of losses.
(d) Property and Equipment
Property and equipment is measured at historical cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment and consists of laboratory equipment, computer
equipment, furniture and fittings and leasehold improvements attributable to the Group’s premises at Melbourne, Victoria, Australia and San Francisco,
USA.
Historical cost includes expenditure that is directly attributable to the acquisition of the item.
Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognised as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is probable that future
economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. The carrying amount of any
component accounted for as a separate asset is derecognised when replaced. All other repairs and maintenance are charged to the income statement during
the reporting period in which they are incurred.
F-12
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(d) Property and Equipment (continued)
Depreciation
Depreciation is provided on property and equipment. Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line method to allocate their cost, net of their residual
values, over their estimated useful lives.
The following estimated useful lives, ranging from 3 to 20 years are used in the calculation of depreciation:
Class of Fixed Asset
Depreciation
Rate
Furniture and fittings
5-33%
Computer equipment
33%
Plant and equipment
10-33%
Leasehold improvements
33%
Leasehold improvements are depreciated over the shorter of the lease term and useful life.
The depreciation method, residual values and useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each annual reporting period.
(e) Leases
The accounting policies for the Group’s lease recognition are explained in note 13.
(f) Investments and other financial assets
Classification
The Group classifies its financial assets in the following measurement categories:
●
those to be measured subsequently at fair value (either through OCI or through profit or loss), and
●
those to be measured at amortized cost.
The classification depends on the entity’s business model for managing the financial assets and the contractual terms of the cash flow. For assets
measured at fair value, gains and losses will either be recorded in profit or loss or OCI. For investments in equity instruments that are not held for trading,
this will depend on whether the Group has made an irrevocable election at the time of initial recognition to account for the equity investment at fair value
through other comprehensive income (FVOCI).
Recognition and derecognition
Regular way purchases and sales of financial assets are recognised on trade-date, the date on which the Group commits to purchase or sell the asset.
Financial assets are derecognised when the rights to receive cash flows from the financial assets have expired or have been transferred and the Group has
transferred substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership.
Measurement
At initial recognition, the Group measures a financial asset at its fair value plus, in the case of a financial asset not at fair value through profit or loss
(FVPL), transaction costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition of the financial asset. Transaction costs of financial assets carried at FVPL are
expensed in profit or loss.
F-13
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(f) Investments and other financial assets (continued)
Assets that are held for collection of contractual cash flows where those cash flows represent solely payments of principal and interest are measured at
amortised cost. Interest income from these financial assets is included in finance income using the effective interest rate method. Any gain or loss arising
on derecognition is recognised directly in profit or loss and presented in other gains/(losses) together with foreign exchange gains and losses. Impairment
losses are presented as separate line item in the consolidated statement of profit or loss.
Equity instruments
The Group subsequently measures all equity investments at fair value. Where the Group’s management has elected to present fair value gains and losses
on equity investments in OCI, there is no subsequent reclassification of fair value gains and losses to profit or loss following the derecognition of the
investment. Dividends from such investments continue to be recognised in profit or loss as other income when the Group’s right to receive payments is
established.
Impairment
The Group assesses on a forward looking basis the expected credit losses associated with its debt instruments carried at amortized cost and FVOCI. The
impairment methodology applied depends on whether there has been a significant increase in credit risk.
For trade receivables, the Group applies the simplified approach which requires expected lifetime losses to be recognised from initial recognition of the
receivables, see note 5 for further details.
(g) Impairment of Assets
At each reporting date, the Group reviews the carrying amounts of its tangible and intangible assets to determine whether there is any indication that
those assets have been impaired. If any such indication exists, the recoverable amount of the asset is estimated to determine the extent of the impairment
loss (if any).
Where the asset does not generate cash flows that are independent from other assets, the Group estimates the recoverable amount of the cash-generating
unit to which the asset belongs.
Recoverable amount is the higher of fair value less costs to sell and value in use. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted
to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset
for which the estimates of future cash flows have not been adjusted.
If the recoverable amount of an asset (or cash-generating unit) is estimated to be less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset (or cash-
generating unit) is reduced to its recoverable amount. An impairment loss is recognised in the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income immediately.
Where an impairment loss subsequently reverses, the carrying amount of the asset (or cash-generating unit) is reversed to the revised estimate of its
recoverable amount, but only to the extent that the increased carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined had
no impairment loss been recognised for the asset (or cash-generating unit) in prior years. A reversal of an impairment loss is recognised in the
consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income immediately.
No impairment charges were incurred during the three years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022.
F-14
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(h) Intangible Assets - Research and Development
Expenditure during the research phase of a project is recognised as an expense when incurred. Where no internally generated intangible assets can be
recognised, development expenditure is recognised as an expense in the period as incurred. Development costs are capitalised if and only if, all of the
following are demonstrated:
●
the technical feasibility of completing the intangible asset so that it will be available for use or sale;
●
the intention to complete the intangible asset and use or sell it;
●
the ability to use or sell the intangible asset;
●
how the intangible asset will generate probable future economic benefits;
●
the availability of adequate technical, financial and other resources to complete the development and to use or sell the intangible asset; and
●
the ability to measure reliably the expenditure attributable to the intangible asset during its development.
Internally-generated intangible assets (capitalised development costs) are stated at cost less accumulated amortisation and impairment, and are amortised
on a straight-line basis over their useful lives over a maximum of five years.
As of June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022, the Group had no capitalized research and development costs.
(i) Foreign Currency Transactions and Balances
Functional and Presentation Currency
Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using Australian dollars, which is the currency of the primary
economic environment in which the Group operates (the functional currency). The consolidated financial statements are presented in Australian dollars
($), which is Alterity Therapeutics Limited’s functional and presentation currency.
Foreign currency transactions
All foreign currency transactions during the financial year are brought to account using the exchange rate in effect at the date of the transaction. Foreign
currency monetary items at each reporting date are translated at the exchange rate existing at each reporting date. Non-monetary assets and liabilities
carried at fair value that are denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the rates prevailing at the date when the fair value was determined.
Exchange differences are recognised in profit or loss in the period in which they arise except for exchange differences on monetary items receivable from
or payable to a foreign operation for which settlement is neither planned or likely to occur, which form part of the net investment in a foreign operation,
are recognised in the foreign currency translation reserve and recognised in profit or loss on disposal of the net investment.
F-15
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(i) Foreign Currency Transactions and Balances (continued)
Subsidiaries
The results and financial position of all the Group’s entities that have a functional currency difference from the presentation currency are translated into
the presentation currency as follows:
●
assets and liabilities for each balance sheet presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that balance sheet, and
●
income and expenses for each income statement are translated at average exchange rates (unless this is not a reasonable approximation of
the cumulative effect of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the dates of the
transactions), and
●
all resulting exchange differences are recognised as a separate component of equity.
On consolidation, the assets and liabilities of the Group’s overseas operations are translated at exchange rates prevailing at the reporting date. Income and
expense items are translated at the average exchange rates for the period unless exchange rates fluctuate significantly. Exchange differences arising, if
any, are recognised in the foreign currency translation reserve, and recognised in profit or loss on disposal of the foreign operations.
(j) Employee Benefits
Short-term obligations
Short-term employee benefits are benefits (other than termination benefits) that are expected to be settled wholly before 12 months after the end of the
annual reporting period in which the employees render the related service, including wages, and salaries. Short-term employee benefits are measured at
the (undiscounted) amounts expected to be paid when the obligation is settled. The Group’s obligations for short-term employee benefits such as wages
and salaries are recognised as a part of current trade and other payables in the statement of financial position.
The Group’s obligations for annual leave are presented as part of provisions in the Statement of Financial Position. The obligations are presented as
current liabilities in the Statement of Financial Position if the Group does not have an unconditional right to defer settlement for at least twelve months
after the reporting period regardless of when the actual settlement is expected to occur.
Other long-term obligations
The liability for long service leave is not expected to be settled wholly within twelve months after the end of the period in which the employees render the
related service. The liability is therefore recognised in the provision for employee benefits and measured as the present value of expected future payments
to be made in respect of services provided by employees up to the end of the reporting period using the projected unit credit method. Consideration is
given to expected future wage and salary levels, experience of employee departures and periods of service. Expected future payments are discounted
using market yields at the end of the reporting period of high quality corporate bonds with terms and currencies that match, as closely as possible, the
estimated future cash outflows. Re-measurements as a result of experience adjustments and changes in actuarial assumptions are recognised in profit or
loss.
The obligations are presented as current liabilities in the balance sheet if the entity does not have an unconditional right to defer settlement for at least
twelve months after the reporting period, regardless of when the actual settlement is expected to occur.
F-16
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(k) Provisions
Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present obligation, the future sacrifice of economic benefits is probable, and the amount of the provision
can be measured reliably.
The amount recognised as a provision is the best estimate of the consideration required to settle the present obligation at reporting date, taking into
account the risks and uncertainties surrounding the obligation. Where a provision is measured using the cash flows estimated to settle the present
obligation, its carrying amount is the present value of those cash flows.
When some or all of the economic benefits required to settle a provision are expected to be recovered from a third party, the receivable is recognised as
an asset if it is virtually certain that recovery will be received and the amount of the receivable can be measured reliably.
(l) Cash and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, deposits held at call with banks and other short-term highly liquid investments with original maturities
of three months or less.
(m) Interest income
Other income is made up of interest income which is recognised on a time proportion basis using the effective interest method.
(n) Grants
Grants are recognised when there is reasonable assurance that the grant will be received and all grant conditions will be complied with.
When the grant relates to an expense item, it is recognised as income over the periods necessary to match the grant on a systematic basis to the costs that
it is expected to compensate.
(o) Goods and Services Tax (“GST”)
Revenues, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of GST, except where the amount of GST incurred is not recoverable from the taxation
authority. In these circumstances the GST is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of an item of expense.
Receivables and payables in the Balance Sheet are shown inclusive of GST. The net amount of GST recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation
authority is included as part of receivables or payables.
Cash flows are included in the Cash Flow Statement on a gross basis. The GST component of cash flows arising from investing and financing activities
which is recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority is classified as operating cash flows.
F-17
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(p) Trade and Other Payables
These amounts represent liabilities for goods and services provided to the Group prior to the end of financial year which are unpaid. The amounts are
unsecured and are usually paid within 30 days of recognition. Trade and other payables are presented as current liabilities unless payment is not due
within 12 months from the reporting date. They are recognised initially at their fair value and subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective
interest method.
(q) Share-Based Payments
The measurement date is determined for share-based payments issued to directors, employees and consultants as follows:
Directors
The issuance of share-based payments to directors is subject to approval by shareholders as per ASX Listing Rule 10.11. The measurement date for share-
based payments issued to directors is the grant date, being the date at which the share-based payments are approved by shareholders.
Employees
The issuance of share-based payments to employees may be subject to shareholder approval per ASX Listing Rule 7.1 which prohibits the issuance of
more than 15% of the Group’s shares in a 12 month period without shareholder approval. The measurement date for share-based payments issued to
employees is the grant date, being the date at which a shared understanding of the terms and conditions of the arrangement is reached. However, if an
issuance to an employee is subject to shareholder approval because it exceeds the 15% threshold per ASX Listing Rule 7.1, then the measurement date of
these share-based payments is the date at which the share-based payments are approved by shareholders.
Consultants
The issuance of share-based payments to consultants may be subject to shareholder approval per ASX Listing Rule 7.1 which prohibits the issuance of
more than 15% of the Group’s shares in a 12 month period without shareholder approval. The measurement date for share-based payments issued to
consultants who provide services considered to be similar to employees is deemed to be the date at which a shared understanding of the terms and
conditions of the arrangement is reached. The measurement date for share-based payments issued to consultants who provide services considered to be
differentiated from those provided by employees is deemed to be the date at which the entity obtains the goods or the counterparty renders the service. If
a service period applies and the work is continually provided over the service period, and if the share price of the Group does not change significantly
during the service period, then the average share price, volatility and risk-free rate over the service period are used in calculating the value of the share-
based payments issued. However, if the underlying share price of the Group does change significantly during the service period, then the value of share-
based payments are calculated at each individual date that goods and services are provided, using the actual valuation inputs at that date. Shares issued to
consultants for services are recorded as non-cash compensation and are recognised at either the fair value of the services rendered, or if this cannot be
reasonably estimated, the fair value of the underlying equity instruments issued. Equity-based compensation benefits are provided to directors, employees
and consultants under the 2004 ASX Plan (the “2004 ASX Plan”) and the 2018 American Depository Share (ADS) Option Plan (the “2018 ADS Plan”).
Information relating to this plan is set out in Note 16.
F-18
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
1. BACKGROUND AND SUMMARY OF MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)
(q) Share-Based Payments (continued)
The fair value of options granted under these plans is recognised as an expense with a corresponding increase in equity. The fair value is measured at
grant date and recognised over the period during which the recipients become unconditionally entitled to the options.
The fair value at grant date is independently determined using a Black-Scholes (for options without market condition) and Barrier Pricing (for options
with market conditions) model that takes into account the exercise price, the term of the option, the impact of dilution, the share price at grant date and
expected price volatility of the underlying share, the expected dividend yield and the risk free interest rate for the term of the option. The expected life
used in the model has been adjusted, based on management’s best estimate, for the effects of non-transferability, exercise restrictions, and behavioral
considerations.
The fair value determined at the grant date of the equity-settled share-based payments is expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based
on the Group’s estimate of shares that will eventually vest.
(r) Loss Per Share
Basic loss per share is determined by dividing the net loss after income tax expense by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding
during the financial period. For all periods presented, diluted loss per share is equivalent to basic loss per share as the potentially dilutive securities are
excluded from the computation of diluted loss per share because the effect is anti-dilutive.
(s) Share Capital
Ordinary share capital is recognised as the fair value of the consideration received by the Group. Any transaction costs arising on the issue of ordinary
shares are recognised directly in equity as a reduction of the share proceeds received.
(t) Trade and Other Receivables
Trade and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method less
provision for impairment.
(u) Comparative Figures
Comparative figures, are, where appropriate, reclassified to be comparable with figures presented in the current financial year.
(v) New Accounting Standards and Interpretations
The Group has adopted all of the new or amended Accounting Standards and Interpretations issued by the International Accounting Standards Board
‘IASB’ and ‘AASB’ that are mandatory for the current reporting period.
The adoption of these standards has not had any material impact on the disclosures or amounts reported in these financial statements.
In April 2024, IFRS 18, “Presentation and Disclosure in Financial Statements” was issued to achieve comparability of the financial performance of
similar entities. The standard, which replaces IAS 1 “Presentation of Financial Statements”, impacts the presentation of primary financial statements and
notes, including the statement of earnings where companies will be required to present separate categories of income and expense for operating,
investing, and financing activities with prescribed subtotals for each new category. The standard will also require management-defined performance
measures to be explained and included in a separate note within the consolidated financial statements. The standard is effective for annual reporting
periods beginning on or after January 1, 2027, including interim financial statements, and requires retrospective application. The Group is currently
assessing the impact of the new standard.
There were no other new accounting standards and interpretations not yet adopted by the Group for the June 30, 2024 reporting period that are expected
to materially impact the Group.
F-19
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
2. INTEREST AND OTHER INCOME FROM CONTINUING OPERATIONS
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Interest income
Interest income
268,419
16,436
2,504
Total interest income
268,419
16,436
2,504
Other income
R&D Tax Incentive (1)
4,019,285
3,914,230
4,669,405
Other grant (2)
-
-
454,120
Miscellaneous Income
-
2,103
-
Total other income
4,019,285
3,916,333
5,123,525
Total interest and other income from continuing operations
4,287,704
3,932,769
5,126,029
(1) A 43.5% R&D Tax incentive refundable tax offset, will be available to eligible small companies with an annual aggregate turnover of less than $20
million. For the years ended June 30, 2024, June 30, 2023 and June 30, 2022, the Group is eligible to receive the refundable tax offset, the
management with input from an independent expert, has applied judgement when assessing activities and expenditures that are likely to be eligible
under the incentive scheme and therefore recorded $4,019,285, $3,914,230 and $4,669,405 in other income, respectively.
(2) Other grant relates to the receipt of grant funding awarded by Michael J. Fox Foundation for Parkinson’s Research during the year ended June 30,
2022.
F-20
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
3. EXPENSES FROM ORDINARY ACTIVITIES
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Research and Development Expenses (1)
Employee expenses
2,456,230
2,720,345
2,517,516
Other research and development expenses
16,187,817
10,478,238
12,228,260
General and Administration Expenses
Depreciation on fixed assets
35,344
37,854
17,848
Depreciation on leased assets
112,185
64,409
36,366
Employee expenses (non R&D related)
515,803
926,314
705,541
Consultant and director expenses
321,000
320,500
390,896
Audit, internal control and other assurance expenses
241,828
238,728
220,798
Corporate compliance expenses
790,350
457,215
401,741
Insurance expenses
676,219
721,732
655,990
Office rental
(9,674)
68,634
79,329
Other administrative and office expenses
1,028,638
1,032,843
911,347
Share based payment expenses
881,950
966,571
1,506,122
Corporate advisory expenses
169,000
204,621
587,937
Other gains and losses
Foreign exchange (gain)/loss
(261,152)
(917,650)
(2,722,430)
(1) Research and development expenses mainly consist of expenses paid for contracted research and development activities conducted by third parties on
behalf of the Group.
F-21
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
4. INCOME TAX
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
(a) Income tax expense:
Current tax
58,463
33,808
50,072
Adjustment for current tax of prior periods
(12,375)
70,651
19,936
Deferred tax
-
-
-
(b) Numerical reconciliation of income tax expense to prima facie tax payable:
Prima facie tax on net loss before income tax at 25% (2023: 25%, 2022: 25%)
(4,769,344)
(3,446,718)
(3,194,263)
Effect of lower tax rates of tax on overseas income
(11,134)
(6,440)
(9,712)
Add tax effect of:
Under/(Over) provision of income tax in previous year relating to a revision of estimates
(12,375)
70,651
19,936
Research and development expenditure (net of tax incentive)
1,305,112
1,267,940
1,516,215
Other
377,405
413,976
529,075
Deferred tax asset not recognised
3,156,424
1,805,050
1,208,757
Income tax expense attributable to loss before income tax
46,088
104,459
70,008
(c) Potential deferred tax asset as of June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022 in respect of: tax losses not
brought to account is (1)(2):
47,758,242
44,056,899
41,204,149
Temporary differences
6,660,171
3,675,742
2,903,797
(1) As of June 30, 2024, the Group had a potential tax benefit related to gross tax losses carried forward of $179,125,289 (2023: $164,311,376) and a
non-refundable R&D tax offset of $3,703,478 (2023: $2,976,920).
(2) Unused tax loss amounts are only attributable to the Group’s operations in Australia, as the subsidiary in the United States has no carryforward tax
losses as of June 30, 2024. Tax losses can be carried forward indefinitely subject to continuity of ownership and same business test rules.
F-22
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
5. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
Accrued interest income
157
656
R&D tax incentive receivable
4,019,286
8,583,635
Goods and services tax receivable
22,232
16,184
Accounts receivable
-
65,229
Total Trade and Other Receivables
4,041,675
8,665,704
R&D tax incentive receivable represents the amount of the financial year 2024 R&D tax incentive the Group expects to recover. For further details, see
note 2.
6. OTHER CURRENT ASSETS
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
Prepayments
2,315,632
2,569,522
Other
40,668
39,764
Total
2,356,300
2,609,286
7. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
Trade creditors
581,137
1,716,135
Accrued research and development expenses
3,499,960
1,458,310
Accrued professional fees
234,899
222,126
Accrued corporate personnel expenses
166,063
-
Other accrued expenses
123,457
87,223
Other payables
14,431
33,914
Total
4,619,947
3,517,708
F-23
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
8. PROVISIONS
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
Current
Annual leave (1)
318,694
420,380
Long service leave (1)(2)
212,005
308,822
Total
530,699
729,202
Non-Current
Long service leave (2)
-
19,503
A provision has been recognised for employee entitlements relating to long service leave. In calculating the present value of future cash flows in respect
of long service leave, the probability of long service leave being taken is based on historical data. The measurement and recognition criteria relating to
employee benefits have been included in Note 1 to this report.
(1) Movements in provisions
Movements in each class of provision during the financial year are set out below:
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Annual leave
Carrying amount at start of year
420,380
371,877
273,876
Charged/(credited) to profit or loss -additional provisions recognised
179,923
272,502
242,532
Amounts used during the year
(280,618)
(232,747)
(158,968)
Change in foreign exchange
(991)
8,748
14,437)
Carrying amount at end of year
318,694
420,380
371,877
Long service leave
Carrying amount at start of year
328,325
298,143
273,260
Charged/(credited) to profit or loss -additional provisions recognised
30,308
30,182
25,210
Amounts used during the year
(146,628)
-
(327)
Carrying amount at end of year
212,005
328,325
298,143
TOTAL
530,699
748,705
670,020
F-24
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
8. PROVISIONS (continued)
(2) Amounts not expected to be settled within the next 12 months
The current provision for long service leave includes all unconditional entitlements where employees have completed the required period of service and
also those where employees are entitled to pro-rata payments in certain circumstances.
The entire amount is presented as current, since the Group does not have an unconditional right to defer settlement. However, based on past experience,
the Group does not expect all employees to take the full amount of accrued long service leave or require payment within the next 12 months. The
following amounts reflect leave that is not expected to be taken or paid within the next 12 months.
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
Long service leave obligation expected to be settled after 12 months
-
19,503
9. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
R&D Tax Incentive
Contingent Asset
In the year ended June 30, 2020, the Group was unsuccessful in obtaining a Commissioner’s Discretion pursuant to subsection 328-126(6) of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1997 regarding the Group’s eligibility to receive the R&D Tax Incentive as a refundable cash offset, so did not recognize a receivable
and other income of $3,363,433 relating to eligible expenditure for that year. The income tax return for the year ended June 30, 2020 has since been
lodged and the R&D Tax Incentive assessed as a non-refundable cash offset. The Group has objected against this assessment.
There are no contingent liabilities at the date of this report. The Group is not involved in any legal or arbitration proceedings and, so far as management is
aware, no such proceedings are pending or threatened against the Group.
In respect of expenditure commitments, refer to Note 15.
F-25
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
10. ISSUED CAPITAL
Years Ended June 30,
Notes
2024
2023
2022
(a) Issued Capital
5,245,115,318 (2023: 2,439,897,618) fully paid ordinary shares
10(b)
223,152,985
213,971,323
213,787,061
Nil (2023: Nil) options for fully paid ordinary shares
10(c)
-
-
-
223,152,985
213,971,323
213,787,061
(b) Movements in Issued Shares
June 30,
2024
2023
2022
No. of shares
A$
No. of shares
A$
No. of shares
A$
Beginning of the year
2,439,897,618
213,971,323
2,406,874,578
213,787,061
2,084,016,678
197,447,990
Movement during the year
2,805,217,700
9,181,662
33,023,040
184,262
322,857,900
16,339,071
End of the year
5,245,115,318
223,152,985
2,439,897,618
213,971,323
2,406,874,578
213,787,061
Details of share issuances are as follows:
Date
Details
Notes
Number
Issue Price
$
Year end June 30, 2021
1,046,658,646
36,744,236
July 2, 2021
Issue of shares under ATM Facility
322,857,900
0.053
17,176,040
June 30, 2022
Security issuance costs
(836,969)
Year end June 30, 2022
322,857,900
16,339,071
September 21, 2022
Issue of shares under ATM Facility
9,543,840
0.0135
128,842
March 15, 2023
Issue of shares under ATM Facility
23,479,200
0.0080
187,834
June 30, 2023
Security issuance costs
(132,413)
Year end June 30, 2023
33,023,040
184,263
November 29, 2023
Issue of shares under ATM Facility
362,462,762
0.0035
1,268,620
January 8, 2024
Issue of shares under ATM Facility
1,008,965,805
0.0035
3,531,380
February 2, 2024
Security issuance costs
571,428,556
0.0035
2,000,000
March 4, 2024
Issue of shares under ATM Facility
855,263,158
0.0038
3,250,000
April 22, 2024
Issue of shares under options exercised
7,097,419
0.0070
49,682
June 30, 2024
Security issuance costs
-
(918,020)
Year end June 30, 2024
2,805,217,700
9,181,662
F-26
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
10. ISSUED CAPITAL (continued)
(c) Terms and Conditions of Issued Capital
Ordinary shares
Ordinary shares have the right to receive dividends as declared and, in the event of a winding up of the Group, to participate in the proceeds from the sale
of all surplus assets in proportion to the number of and amounts paid up on shares held. Ordinary shares entitle their holder to vote, either in person or by
proxy, at a meeting of the Group’s shareholders.
Options
Option holders do not have the right to receive dividends and are not entitled to vote at a meeting of the Group’s shareholders. Options may be exercised
at any time from the date they vest to the date of their expiration. Share options convert into ordinary shares on a one for one basis on the date they are
exercised.
(d) Shares Issued after Reporting Date
No shares have been issued after the reporting date.
11. RESERVES
(a) Share Based Payments
Years Ended June 30,
Notes
2024
2023
2022
3,250,009,092 (2023: 170,042,720 , 2022: 184,692,720) options for fully paid
ordinary shares
11(c)
4,806,203
3,972,475
3,565,918
4,806,203
3,972,475
3,565,918
The share-based payment reserve is used to recognize the fair value of options issued to directors, executives, employees and consultants but not
exercised. Amounts are transferred out of the reserve and into issued capital when the options are exercised. When options expire, the amount is
transferred from reserve to accumulated losses.
F-27
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
11. RESERVES (continued)
(b) Warrants/Free-attaching options
Years Ended June 30,
Notes
2024
2023
2022
2,875,563,791 free-attaching options (2023: 674,694,939 free-attaching options,
2022: 674,694,939) for fully paid ordinary shares (1)
11(c)
-
-
-
-
-
-
1.
On November 24, 2020 as part of a two tranche placement to sophisticated and professional investors the Group issued a total of 674,694,939 free
attaching warrants with an exercise price of A$0.07, expiring on November 23, 2023. These warrants were assessed to have immaterial value at the
time of issue.
On January 8, 2024 a total of 457,142,830 free attaching options with an exercise price of A$0.01, expiring on August 31, 2026 were issued. On
January 8, 2024 a total of 1,371,428,567 free attaching options with an exercise price of A$0.007, expiring on August 31, 2024 were issued.
On February 2, 2024 a total of 190,476,123 free attaching options with an exercise price of A$0.002, expiring on August 31, 2026 were issued.
On February 2, 2024 a total of 571,428,556 free attaching options with an exercise price of A$0.007, expiring on August 31, 2024 were issued.
On April 15, 2024 a total of 285,087,715 free attaching options with an exercise price of A$0.01, expiring on August 31, 2026 were issued.
(c) Movements in Options for Fully Paid Ordinary Shares
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Number of
Options
(A$)
Number of
Options
(A$)
Number of
Options
(A$)
Beginning of the year
170,042,720
3,972,475
184,692,720
3,565,918
160,542,720
2,750,884
Options issued during the year
3,092,563,791
-
-
-
45,150,000
-
Expired during the year
-
-
(13,150,000)
(560,014)
(7,000,000)
(240,310)
Forfeited during the year
(5,500,000)
(93,222)
(1,500,000)
(17,150)
(14,000,000)
(450,777)
Shares to be issued
-
45,000
Share Based Payment expense
-
881,950
-
983,721
-
1,506,121
End of the year
3,250,009,092
4,806,203
170,042,720
3,972,475
184,692,720
3,565,918
Details of option grants are summarized as follows.
Year ended June 30, 2022:
●
On December 8, 2021, 13,900,000 options were issued to the Group’s employees and consultants based in the United States under the 2018
ADS Plan. The options are exercisable at A$0.0238 and expire on November 29, 2026. The fair value of the options is A$0.021 per option.
●
On December 8, 2021, 19,250,000 options were issued to the Group’s employees and consultants based in Australia under the 2004 ASX
Plan. The options are exercisable at A$0.0375 and expire on November 29, 2026. The fair value of the options is A$0.021 per option.
●
On December 8, 2021, 12,000,000 options were issued to a consultant under the 2004 ASX Plan. The options are exercisable at A$0.07 and
expire on July 31, 2024. The fair value of the options is A$0.027 per option.
●
On January 4, 2022, 14,000,000 options were forfeited upon resignation of two Non-Executive Directors.
●
On June 6, 2022, 7,000,000 options expired.
F-28
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
11. RESERVES (continued)
(c) Movements in Options for Fully Paid Ordinary Shares (continued)
Year ended June 30, 2023:
●
On December 14, 2022, 12,450,000 options expired.
●
On January 31, 2023, 700,000 options expired.
●
On April 3, 2023, 1,500,000 options were forfeited upon resignation of an employee.
Year ended June 30, 2024:
●
On September 11, 2023, 500,000 options were forfeited upon resignation of an employee.
●
On December 21, 2023, 8,000,000 options were issued to the Group’s employees based in Australia under the 2004 ASX Plan. The options
are exercisable at A$0.0105 and expire on December 19, 2026. The fair value of the options is A$0.005 per option. On January 31, 2023,
700,000 options expired.
●
On January 08, 2024, 457,142,830 long dated options were issued as per the placement. The options are exercisable at A$0.01 and expire on
August 31, 2026.
●
On January 08, 2024, 1,371,418,567 free attaching short - dated options were issued as per the placement. The options are exercisable at
A$0.007 and expire on August 31, 2024.
●
On February 02, 2024, 190,476,123 long dated options were issued as per the securities placement plan. The options are exercisable at
A$0.002 and expire on August 31, 2026.
●
On January 4, 2022, 14,000,000 options were forfeited upon resignation of two Non-Executive Directors.
●
On February 02, 2024, 571,428,556 short - dated options were issued as per the securities placement plan. The options are exercisable at
A$0.007 and expire on August 31, 2024.
●
On April 15, 2024, 285,087,725 short – free attaching options were issued as per the securities placement plan. The options are exercisable
at A$0.01 and expire on August 31, 2024
●
On April 22, 2024, 7,097,419 options were exercised.
●
On May 21, 2024, 5,000,000 options were forfeited upon resignation of an employee.
●
On June 27, 2024, 26,500,000 options were issued to the Group’s employees based under the 2004 ASX Plan. The options are exercisable at
A$0.004 and expire on March 13, 2029. The fair value of the options is A$0.004 per option.
●
On June 27, 2024, 62,500,000 options were issued to the Group’s employees based under the Company’s 2018 American Depositary Share
(ADS) Option Plan. The options are exercisable at US$0.0031 (A$0.0046) and expire on March 13, 2029. The fair value of the options is
A$0.0037 per option.
●
On June 27, 2024, 120,000,000 options were issued to the Group’s key management personnel based under the Company’s 2018 American
Depositary Share (ADS) Option Plan. The options are exercisable at US$0.003 (A$0.0044) and expire on March 21, 2029. The fair value of
the options is A$0.0037 per option.
F-29
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
11. RESERVES (continued)
(d) Terms and Conditions of Reserves
Options and warrants
Option holders and warrant holders do not have the right to receive dividends and are not entitled to vote at a meeting of the Group’s shareholders.
Options and warrants may be exercised at any time from the date they vest to the date of their expiration. Share options are exercisable into ordinary
shares on a one for one basis on the date they are exercised. Options granted under the 2018 ADS Plan are exercisable into ADRs, being one option for
one ADR, which equals 600 ordinary shares, on the date they are exercised.
Expired options are reclassified into accumulated losses. Options forfeited due to failure of a vesting condition result in a reversal of the accumulated
expense through the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive loss.
In Australia, there is not a set number of authorized shares, shares are not reserved for the exercise of options, and shares do not have a par value.
(e) Options and Warrants Issued after Reporting Date
No options were issued after reporting date.
12. ACCUMULATED DEFICIT DURING DEVELOPMENT STAGE
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Balance at beginning of year
195,130,889
181,884,388
169,728,414
Net loss for the year
19,123,464
13,806,515
12,847,061
Reclassify expired options from reserves
-
(560,014)
(240,310)
Reclassify forfeited options from reserves
(93,222)
-
(450,777)
Balance at end of year
214,161,131
195,130,889
181,884,388
F-30
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
13. LEASES
(i)
Amounts recognised in the statement of financial position
The statement of financial position shows the following amounts relating to leases:
Years Ended June 30,
Right-of-use assets
2024
2023
2022
Right-of-use assets
154,729
207,087
115,971
Lease liabilities
Current
107,131
107,177
57,632
Non-current
51,914
103,207
59,857
159,045
210,384
117,489
Additions to the right-of-use assets during the current financial year were $59,031 (2023: $152,817, 2022: $86,353).
(ii) Amounts recognised in the statement of profit or loss
The statement of profit or loss shows the following amounts relating to leases:
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
112,185
64,409
36,366
Interest expense
7,217
4,565
2,285
Expenses relating to short-term leases (included in general and administration expenses)
(9,674)
68,634
79,309
Expenses relating to variable lease payments not included in lease liabilities (included in general
and administration expenses)
-
-
-
The total cash outflow for leases in 2024 was $7,913 (2023: $133,121, 2022: $116,107).
(iii) The Group’s leasing activities and how these are accounted for
The Group has adopted IFRS 16 Leases during the year ended June 30, 2020 using the modified retrospective approach. The modified approach does not
require restatement of comparative periods. Instead the cumulative impact of applying IFRS 16 is accounted for as an adjustment to equity at the start of
the current financial year in which it was first applied, known as the ‘date of initial application’. Refer to note 1(v) for further details.
Leases are recognised as a right-of-use asset and a corresponding liability at the date at which the leased asset is available for use by the Group. Each
lease payment is allocated between the liability and finance cost. The finance cost is charged to profit or loss over the lease year so as to produce a
constant periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability for each year. The right-of-use asset is depreciated over the shorter of the asset’s
useful life and the lease term on a straight-line basis.
Assets and liabilities arising from a lease are initially measured on a present value basis. Lease liabilities include the net present value of the following
lease payments:
●
fixed payments (including in-substance fixed payments), less any lease incentives receivable
●
variable lease payment that are based on an index or a rate
●
amounts expected to be payable by the lessee under residual value guarantees
●
the exercise price of a purchase option if the lessee is reasonably certain to exercise that option, and
●
payments of penalties for terminating the lease, if the lease term reflects the lessee exercising that option.
F-31
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
13. LEASES (continued)
The lease payments are discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease, if that rate can be determined, or the Group’s incremental borrowing rate
applied at the commencement date.
Right-of-use assets are measured at cost comprising the following:
●
the amount of the initial measurement of lease liability
●
any lease payments made at or before the commencement date, less any lease incentives received
●
any initial direct costs, and
●
restoration costs.
Payments associated with short-term leases and leases of low-value assets are recognised on a straight-line basis as an expense in profit or loss. Short-
term leases are leases with a lease term of 12 months or less.
14. CASH FLOW INFORMATION
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
(a) Reconciliation of Net Loss to Net Cash Flows Used In Operations
Net loss
(19,123,464)
(13,806,515)
(12,847,061)
Non-cash items
Depreciation of property and equipment
35,344
37,854
17,848
Depreciation on leased assets
112,185
64,409
36,366
Others
-
-
61
Share-based payment expenses
881,950
966,571
1,506,122
Foreign exchange (gain)/loss
(261,152)
(917,650)
(2,813,635)
Fixed Asset Write Off
-
10,232
-
Changes in assets and liabilities
(Increase)/Decrease in trade and other receivables
4,624,029
(3,940,343)
(447,684)
(Increase)/Decrease in other current assets
252,986
(968,207)
(516,176)
Increase/(Decrease) in trade and other payables
1,102,239
(1,560,873)
2,604,001
(Decrease) in other current liabilities
(11,935)
-
-
Increase/(Decrease) in provision for employee entitlements
(218,006)
78,685
122,884
Net cash flows used in operating activities
(12,605,824)
(20,035,837)
(12,337,274)
(b) Reconciliation of Cash and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents balance comprises:
- cash and cash equivalents on hand
12,638,885
15,773,783
34,806,799
Closing cash and cash equivalents balance
12,638,885
15,773,783
34,806,799
(c) Non-Cash Financing and Investing Activities
There were no non-cash financing and investing activities during the years ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022.
F-32
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
15. EXPENDITURE COMMITMENTS
As of June 30, 2024, the Group no longer has short term leases contracted for but not capitalized in the financial statements. As of June 30, 2023, the
Group no longer has short term leases contracted for but not capitalized in the financial statements.
The majority of our contracts for research and development programs have a termination notice period of 30 days. As of June 30, 2024, we had research
and development termination commitments approximating A$3.4 million. No liability has been recognised within our financial statements for this period.
In addition, we have the ability to scale down our operations and prioritise our research and development programs to reduce expenditures.
Details in relation to commitments under employee service agreements with Directors and Key Management Personnel are outlined in Note 21.
16. SHARE BASED PAYMENTS
At the Annual General Meeting held on November 17, 2004, the shareholders approved the establishment of employee and consultant plans designed to
reward directors, employees and consultants for their contributions to the Group. The plans are to be used as a method of retaining key personnel for the
growth and development of the Group. Due to Alterity’s U.S. presence, a U.S. plan (the 2018 ADS Plan) and an Australian plan (the 2004 ASX Plan)
were developed.
As of June 30, 2024, equity had been issued to 3 Directors, 1 Key Management Personnel, 7 employees and 4 consultants under the 2004 ASX Plan and
2018 ADS Plan.
As of June 30, 2023, equity had been issued to 4 Directors, 2 Key Management Personnel, 9 employees and 3 consultants under the 2004 ASX Plan and
2018 ADS Plan.
As of June 30, 2022, equity had been issued to 4 Directors, 2 former Directors, 2 Key Management Personnel, 10 employees and 4 consultants under the
2004 ASX Plan and 2018 ADS Plan.
At the 2004 Annual General Meeting, shareholders authorized the Group to issue in the aggregate up to 12 million ordinary shares under the two plans.
This was increased to 22 million ordinary shares at the 2005 Annual General Meeting and further increased to 30 million ordinary shares at the 2007
Annual General Meeting, 45 million ordinary shares at the 2008 Annual General Meeting and 60 million ordinary shares at the 2009 Annual General
Meeting. At the September 2020 General Meeting, shareholders authorized the Group to issue up to 157.5 million securities. At the 2020 Annual General
Meeting, shareholders authorized the Group to issue up to 200 million ordinary shares. At the 2022 Annual General Meeting, shareholders authorized the
Group to issue up to 240 million ordinary shares.
The Share Plan Committee, a sub-committee of the Remuneration Committee administers the two plans and is able to change the terms of the equity
issued under them from the default terms.
Under the 2018 ADS Plan, the exercise price must equal or exceed the fair value of the ADS on the date the options are awarded. The option expiration
date cannot exceed ten years from the date the options were awarded. The default vesting conditions are 25% per year on the date the options were
awarded.
Under the 2004 ASX Plan, the exercise price must be equal or be less than the market value of the ordinary shares on ASX on the date of grant. The
option expiration date cannot exceed ten years from the date the options were granted. The default vesting conditions are 25% per year on the date the
options were granted.
F-33
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
16. SHARE BASED PAYMENTS (continued)
Information with respect to the number of options granted under the 2004 ASX Plan and 2018 ADS Plan as follows:
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Number of
Options
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price (A$)
Number of
Options
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price (A$)
Number of
Options
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price (A$)
Beginning of the year
170,042,720
0.047
184,692,720
0.05
160,542,720
0.09
Issued during the year
217,000,000
0.004
-
-
45,150,000
0.04
Exercised during the year
-
-
-
-
-
-
Expired during the year
-
-
(13,150,000)
0.11
(7,000,000)
0.07
Forfeited during the year
(5,500,000)
0.036
(1,500,000)
0.02
(14,000,000)
0.09
Outstanding at year end
381,542,720
0.022
170,042,720
0.05
184,692,720
0.05
Vested and Exercisable at year end
195,708,100
0.033
87,280,755
0.06
60,150,000
0.09
Options outstanding at the end of the year have the following expiry date and exercise prices:
Series
Grant Date
Expiry Date
Exercise
Price
Share options
Share options
$A
2024
2023
ATHAAB
September 18, 2020
September 17, 2025
0.09
35,000,000
35,000,000
ATHAAD
January 7, 2021
January 6, 2026
0.03
91,392,720
91,392,720
ATHAAE
November 29, 2021
November 29, 2026
0.04
14,250,000
19,250,000
ATHAAF
July 31, 2021
July 31, 2024
0.07
12,000,000
12,000,000
ATHAAG
November 21, 2021
November 29, 2026
0.02
11,900,000
12,400,000
ATHAAH
December 21, 2023
December 19, 2026
0.001
8,000,000
-
ATHAA
March 13, 2024
March 13, 2029
0.004
26,500,000
-
ATHAB
March 13, 2024
March 13, 2029
0.005
62,500,000
-
ATHAC
March 21, 2024
March 21, 2029
0.003
120,000,000
Total
381,542,720
170,042,720
Weighted average remaining contractual life of options outstanding at end of period.
3.28 years
2.53 years
Risk free interest rate – This is the government bond rate (having a term that most closely resembles the expected life of the option) in effect at the grant
date. The Australian government bond rate has been used for options which are exercisable for fully paid ordinary shares and the U.S. government bond
rate has been used for options which are exercisable for ADRs.
Dividend yield – Alterity has never declared or paid dividends on its ordinary shares and does not anticipate paying any dividends in the foreseeable
future.
Expected volatility – Alterity estimates expected volatility based on historical volatility over the estimated life of the option and other factors. Historical
volatility has been the basis for determining expected share price volatility as it is assumed that this is indicative of future movements. The life of the
options is based on historical exercise patterns, which may not eventuate in the future.
Expected life – This is the period of time that the options granted are expected to remain outstanding. This estimate is based primarily on historical trend
of option holders to exercise their option near the date of expiry. As a result, the expected life is considered to equal the period from grant date to expiry
date.
F-34
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
16. SHARE BASED PAYMENTS (continued)
Model inputs –
The model inputs for the valuations of options approved and issued during the current and previous financial years are as follows:
Series
Grant Date
Exercise
Price
per Share
Share
Price
at Grant
Date
Expected
Share
Price
Volatility
Years to
Expiry
Dividend
Yield
Risk-free
Interest
Rate
Fair Value
per
Options
A$
A$
A$
ATHAAB
September 18,2020
0.09
0.05
98.00%
5.00
0%
0.43%
0.032
ATHAAD
January 7,2021
0.03
0.032
139.52%
5.00
0%
0.38%
0.028
ATHAAE
November 29, 2021
0.04
0.025
138.47%
5.00
0%
1.35%
0.021
ATHAAF
July 31, 2021
0.07
0.034
169.42%
5.00
0%
0.13%
0.027
ATHAAG
November 29, 2021
0.02
0.0238
138.47%
5.00
0%
1.35%
0.021
ATHAAH
December 21, 2023
0.01
0.0065
133.87%
3.00
0%
3.67%
0.005
ATHAA
March 13, 2024
0.004
0.004
158.31%
5.00
0%
3.47%
0.004
ATHAB
March 13, 2024
0.004
0.004
158.31%
5.00
0%
3.47%
0.004
ATHAC
March 21, 2024
0.003
0.004
158.83%
5.00
0%
3.48%
0.004
Information with respect to the number of shares issued under the stock option plan as follows:
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Number of
Shares
Number of
Shares
Number of
Shares
Beginning of the year
13,277,715
13,277,715
13,277,715
Issued during the year
-
-
-
End of the financial year
13,277,715
13,277,715
13,277,715
No shares were granted during the year ended June 30, 2024, 2023 and 2022.
17. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
On 17 July 2024 Alterity Therapeutics announced positive interim data from the ATH434-202 phase 2 clinical trial. The interim analysis included clinical
and biomarker data on participants treated with ATH434, as well as neuroimaging data.
As announced on 18 July 2024, the Group issued 75,220,800 shares at $0.0054 per share through the use of its “at market” (ATM) facility amounting to
$406,192. This will fund working capital and progress its research and development activities.
No other matter or circumstance has occurred subsequent to year end that has significantly affected, or may significantly affect, the operations of the
Group, the results of those operations or the state of affairs of the Group or economic entity in subsequent financial years.
On 31 August 2024 1,935,759,704 free attaching options expired.
F-35
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
18. LOSS PER SHARE
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Basic and diluted loss per share (cents per share)
(0.52)
(0.57)
(0.53)
Weighted average number of ordinary shares on issue used in the calculation of basic and diluted
loss per share
3,648,875,564
2,427,841,917
2,405,990,036
The options and warrants in place do not have the effect of diluting the loss per share. Therefore, they have been excluded from the calculation of diluted
loss per share. Please refer to Note 11 and Note 16 for options and warrants on issue which were assessed to be antidilutive.
19. KEY MANAGEMENT PERSONNEL COMPENSATION
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
Short-term employee benefits
1,537,843
1,727,020
1,641,015
Post-employment benefits
38,486
42,444
44,121
Long-term benefits
6,616
7,215
6,711
Termination benefits
10,215
-
-
Share-based payments
552,622
764,175
998,164
2,145,782
2,540,854
2,690,011
20. AUDITORS’ REMUNERATION
Years Ended June 30,
2024
2023
2022
- Audit and review of financial statements (1)
248,200
246,400
216,400
- Other audit services (2)
95,500
52,000
-
343,700
298,400
216,400
1.
Audit and review of financial statements consist of fees billed for assurance and related services that generally only the statutory auditor could
reasonably provide to a client.
2.
Included in the balance are amounts related to additional regulatory filings during the 2023 financial years. All services provided are considered audit
services for the purpose of SEC classification.
PricewaterhouseCoopers was appointed as the Group’s principal independent registered public accounting firm on November 30, 2006. Australian law
does not require the Group’s Auditors to be appointed at the Group’s annual general meeting of shareholders. There is an annual engagement letter which
is signed, subject to the Group’s audit committee approval, with PricewaterhouseCoopers for audit and review work. No non-audit services were
provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers during the 2024, 2023 and 2022 financial years.
F-36
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
21. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
a.
Equity Interests in Subsidiaries
Alterity Therapeutics Limited owns 100% of its subsidiaries, Alterity Therapeutics Inc. and Alterity Therapeutics UK Ltd.
b.
Key Management Personnel Remuneration
The Directors of Alterity during the year:
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler, Chairman
Mr. Brian Meltzer, Independent Non-Executive Director
Mr. Peter Marks, Independent Non-Executive Director
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan, Non-Executive Director
The Key Management Personnel of the Group during the year:
Dr. David Stamler
Chief Executive Officer
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
Chief Financial Officer – Resigned 30 January 2024
Remuneration of all key management personnel of the Group is determined by the Board of Directors following recommendation by the Remuneration
Committee.
The Group is committed to remunerating senior executives in a manner that is market competitive and consistent with ‘best practice’ including the
interests of shareholders. Remuneration packages are based on fixed and variable components, determined by the executive’s position, experience and
performance, and may be satisfied via cash or equity.
Non-executive Directors are remunerated out of the aggregate amount approved by shareholders and at a level that is consistent with industry standards.
Non-executive Directors do not receive performance based bonuses and prior shareholder approval is required to participate in any issuance of equity. No
retirement benefits are payable other than statutory superannuation, if applicable.
The Group’s remuneration policy is not solely based on the Group’s performance, but also on industry practice.
The Group’s primary focus is research activities with a long term objective of developing and commercializing its research and development results.
The Group envisages its performance in terms of earnings will remain negative whilst the Group continues in the research and clinical trials. Shareholder
wealth reflects this speculative and volatile market sector. This pattern is indicative of the Group’s performance over the past four years.
The purpose of a performance bonus is to reward individual performance in line with Group objectives. Consequently, performance based remuneration
is paid to an individual where the individual’s performance clearly contributes to a successful outcome for the Group. This is regularly measured in
respect of performance against key performance indicators (“KPI’s”).
The Group uses a variety of KPI’s to determine achievement, depending on the role of the executive being assessed.
F-37
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
21. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (continued)
b.
Key Management Personnel Remuneration (continued)
Post-
Long Term
2024
Short Term
Benefits
Employment
Superannuation
Benefits
Long-service
Termination
Equity
Base Fee
Bonus
Contribution
Leave
Benefit
Options
Total
Directors’ remuneration
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
Mr.
Geoffrey Kempler (2)
269,000
-
11,000
-
-
-
313,300
Mr. Brian Meltzer
63,348
-
6,937
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Peter Marks
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
472,063
-
17,937
-
-
-
490,000
Other key management
personnel
Dr. David Stamler (3)
716,615
166,063
-
(13,232)
-
552,622
1,422,068
Ms. Kathryn Andrews (1)
196,334
-
20,549
6,616
10,215
(32,567)
201,147
912,949
166,063
20,549
6,616
10,215
520,055
1,623,215
Total
1,385,012
166,063
38,486
6,616
10,215
520,055
2,113,215
(1) Ms. Kathryn Andrews resigned 30 January 2024 and served out her notice period accordingly. The unvested FY21 equity options for Kathryn
Andrews were forfeited due to cessation of employment.
(2) Includes $169,000 corporate advisory fees paid to an associate entity of Mr. Geoffrey Kempler for business advisory services including investor
relations, marketing and business development.
(3) Dr. David Stamler gets paid in US dollars.
2023
Short Term
Benefits
Superannuation
Long-service
Termination
Equity
Base Fee
Bonus
Contribution
Leave
Benefit
Options
Total
Directors’remuneration
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
Mr. GeoffreyKempler
(2)
302,800
-
10,500
-
-
-
313,300
Mr. Brian Meltzer
63,348
-
6,652
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Peter Marks
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
506,148
-
17,152
-
-
-
523,300
Other key management
personnel
Dr. David Stamler (1)
731,381
194,570
-
-
-
724,047
1,649,998
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
(1)
294,921
-
25,292
7,215
-
40,128
367,556
1,026,302
194,570
25,292
7,215
-
764,175
2,017,554
Total
1,532,450
194,570
42,444
7,215
-
764,175
2,540,854
(1) Base Fee includes movements in the annual leave provision for Ms. Kathryn Andrews and Dr. David Stamler in accordance with their employment
contracts.
(2) Includes A$202,800 in corporate advisory fees paid to an associated entity of Mr. Geoffrey Kempler for business advisory services including
investor relations, marketing and business development.
F-38
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
21. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (continued)
b.
Key Management Personnel Remuneration (continued)
Post-
Long Term
2022
Short Term
Benefits
Employment
Superannuation
Benefits
Long-service
Termination
Equity
Base Fee
Bonus
Contribution
Leave
Benefit
Options
Total
Directors’ remuneration
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
A$
Mr. Geoffrey
Kempler (2)
377,800
-
10,000
-
-
-
387,800
Mr. Brian Meltzer
63,636
-
6,359
-
-
-
69,995
Mr. Peter Marks
70,000
-
-
-
-
-
70,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan (3)
107,500
-
-
-
-
-
107,500
Dr. David Sinclair (4)
34,888
-
-
-
-
-
34,888
Mr. Tristan Edwards (4)
31,819
-
4,194
-
-
-
36,013
685,643
-
20,553
-
-
-
706,196
Other key management
personnel
Dr. David Stamler (1)
658,393
-
-
-
-
965,633
1,624,026
Ms. Kathryn Andrews (1)
296,979
-
23,568
6,711
-
32,531
359,789
955,372
-
23,568
6,711
-
998,164
1,983,815
Total
1,641,015
-
44,121
6,711
-
998,164
2,690,011
(1) Base Fee includes movements in the annual leave provision for Ms. Kathryn Andrews and Dr. David Stamler in accordance with their employment
contracts.
(2) Includes A$277,800 in corporate advisory fees paid to an associated entity of Mr. Geoffrey Kempler for business advisory services including
investor relations, marketing and business development.
(3) Includes A$37,500 in corporate advisory fees paid to an associated entity of Mr. Lawrence Gozlan for corporate advisory services including seeking
and advancing opportunities to expand the Group’s product pipeline and other sources of funding to commence and continue the Group’s clinical
trials.
(4) David Sinclair and Tristan Edwards resigned on January 4, 2022.
F-39
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
21. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (continued)
b.
Key Management Personnel Remuneration (continued)
The following Senior Executives were under contract during the year ended June 30, 2024:
Key management personnel
Duration
Notice Requirements
Termination
Kathryn Andrews
*Resigned January 30,2024
Until termination by either party.
Signed November 11, 2014
Ms Andrews may terminate with 30
days’ notice, or
Accrued entitlements including all
unreimbursed business expenses.
Without Cause the Group may
terminate with 30 days’ notice, or
With Cause the Group may terminate
without notice
Permitted to keep and/or exercise
options that have vested at the time of
termination.
David Stamler
Until termination by either party.
Signed January 6, 2021.
Each party will be required to provide 6
months’ notice of termination unless
otherwise agreed to in writing.
Accrued entitlements including all
unreimbursed business expenses.
Vested but unexercised options shall
be exercisable within 30 days after the
date of termination.
Unvested options will terminate
automatically without further notice.
For good reason, Dr Stamler may
terminate at any time upon written
notice.
Payment equivalent to one hundred
percent of current annualized salary.
Accrued entitlements including all
unreimbursed business expenses.
Vested but unexercised options shall
be exercisable within 30 days after the
date of termination.
Unvested options will terminate
automatically without further notice.
With Cause, the Group may terminate
at any time upon written notice
Payment limited to accrued salary,
accrued but unused vacation pay and
approved but unreimbursed expenses
that are owed to date of termination
All options shall be canceled upon
date of termination
F-40
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
21. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (continued)
c.
Key Management Personnel Equity Holdings
Balance
July 1,
2023
Received as
Remuneration
Received on
Exercise of
Options
Net Change
Other
Balance
June 30,
2024
Fully Paid Ordinary Shares of the Group
No.
No.
No.
No.
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
18,011,000
-
-
-
18,011,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
326,666
-
-
7,142,857
7,469,523
Mr. Peter Marks
43,111
-
-
7,142,857
7,185,968
Ms. Kathryn Andrews (2)
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler
3,555,000
-
-
7,142,857
10,697,857
21,935,777
-
-
21,428,571
43,364,000
Balance
July 1,
2022
Received as
Remuneration
Received on
Exercise of
Options
Net Change
Other
Balance
June 30,
2023
Fully Paid Ordinary Shares of the Group
No.
No.
No.
No.
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
18,011,000
-
-
-
18,011,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
326,666
-
-
-
326,666
Mr. Peter Marks
43,111
-
-
-
43,111
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler
-
-
-
3,555,000
3,555,000
18,380,777
-
-
3,555,000
21,935,777
Balance
July 1,
2021
Received as
Remuneration
Received on
Exercise of
Options
Net Change
Other
Balance
June 30,
2022
Fully Paid Ordinary Shares of the Group
No.
No.
No.
No.
No.
Mr. Geoffrey Kempler
18,011,000
-
-
-
18,011,000
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
326,666
-
-
-
326,666
Mr. Peter Marks
43,111
-
-
-
43,111
Dr. David Sinclair (1)
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Tristan Edwards (1)
-
-
-
-
-
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler
-
-
-
-
-
18,380,777
-
-
-
18,380,777
(1) David Sinclair and Tristan Edwards resigned on January 4, 2022.
(2) Kathryn Andrews resigned January 30,2024 David Sinclair and Tristan Edwards resigned on January 4, 2022.
F-41
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
21. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (continued)
c
Key Management Personnel Equity Holdings (continued)
Share Options of
the Group
Balance
July 1,
2023
No.
Granted as
Remuneration
No.
Options
Exercised
No.
Options
Expired
No.
Options
Forfeited
No.
Net
Change
Other
Options
Vested
During
the year
Balance
June 30,
2024
No.
Total
Vested and
Exercisable
June 30,
2024
No.
Total
Unvested
June 30,
2024
No.
Mr. Geoffrey
Kempler
14,000,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
14,000,000
14,000,000
-
Mr. Lawrence
Gozlan
7,000,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
7,000,000
-
-
-
-
9,523,809
-
16,523,809
16,523,809
-
Mr. Peter Marks
7,000,000
-
-
-
-
9,523,809
-
16,523,809
16,523,809
-
Ms. Kathryn
Andrews(1)
5,000,000
-
-
- (5,000,000)
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. David Stamler
91,392,720
120,000,000
-
-
-
9,523,809
- 220,916,529 104,740,244 116,176,285
131,392,720
120,000,000
-
- (5,000,000) 28,571,427
- 274,964,147 158,787,862 116,176,285
1)
Kathryn Andres resigned on January 30, 2024
Share Options of the
Group
Balance
July 1,
2022
No.
Granted as
Remuneration
No.
Options
Exercised
No.
Options
Expired
No.
Options
Forfeited
No.
Net
Change
Other
Options
Vested
During
the year
Balance
June 30,
2023
No.
Total
Vested and
Exercisable
June 30,
2023
No.
Total
Unvested
June 30,
2023
No.
Mr. Geoffrey
Kempler
19,000,000
-
- (5,000,000)
-
-
-
14,000,000
14,000,000
-
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
8,250,000
-
- (1,250,000)
-
-
-
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
8,250,000
-
- (1,250,000)
-
-
-
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Mr. Peter Marks
8,250,000
-
- (1,250,000)
-
-
-
7,000,000
7,000,000
-
Ms. Kathryn Andrews
5,000,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
5,000,000
1,250,000
3,750,000
Dr. David Stamler
91,392,720
-
-
-
-
-
-
91,392,720
32,368,255 59,024,465
140,142,720
-
- (8,750,000)
-
-
- 131,392,720
68,618,255 62,774,465
Share Options of the
Group
Balance
July 1,
2021
No.
Granted as
Remuneration
No.
Options
Exercised
No.
Options
Expired
No.
Options
Forfeited
No.
Net
Change
Other
Options
Vested
During
the year
Balance
June 30,
2022
No.
Total
Vested and
Exercisable
June 30,
2022
No.
Total
Unvested
June 30,
2022
No.
Mr. Geoffrey
Kempler
19,000,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
19,000,000
19,000,000
-
Mr. Lawrence Gozlan
8,250,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
8,250,000
8,250,000
-
Mr. Brian Meltzer
8,250,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
8,250,000
8,250,000
-
Mr. Peter Marks
8,250,000
-
-
-
-
-
-
8,250,000
8,250,000
-
Dr. David Sinclair (1)
7,000,000
-
-
-
(7,000,000)
-
-
-
-
-
Mr. Tristan Edwards
(1)
7,000,000
-
-
-
(7,000,000)
-
-
-
-
-
Ms. Kathryn
Andrews
500,000
5,000,000
-
(500,000)
-
-
-
5,000,000
-
5,000,000
Dr. David Stamler
95,392,720
-
- (4,000,000)
-
-
-
91,392,720
- 91,392,720
153,642,720
5,000,000
- (4,500,000) (14,000,000)
-
- 140,142,720
43,750,000 96,392,720
(1) David Sinclair and Tristan Edwards resigned on January 4, 2022.
F-42
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
22. SEGMENT INFORMATION
The Group’s Chief Executive Officer (Chief Operating Decision Maker) examines internal reports to assess the Group’s performance and determine the
allocation of resources. The Group’s has identified one reportable segment as a whole and cover research into Parkinsonian movement disorders,
Alzheimer’s disease, Huntington disease, and other neurodegenerative disorders.
23. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The Group’s activities expose it to a variety of financial risks including market risk, credit risk and liquidity risk. The Group’s overall risk management
program focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimize potential adverse effects on the financial performance of the Group.
Risk management is carried out under policies approved by the Board of Directors and overseen by the Audit Committee.
(a) Market Risk
(i)
Foreign Currency Risk
The Group engages in international purchase transactions and is exposed to foreign currency risk arising from various currency exposures, primarily with
respect to the Australian dollar. The parent entity also has exposure to foreign exchange risk in the currency cash reserves it holds to meet its foreign
currency payments. The Group does not make use of derivative financial instruments to hedge foreign exchange risk.
The following financial assets and liabilities are subject to foreign currency risk, the currency of the original amounts are displayed in brackets, all the
amounts in the table below are displayed in A$ at year-end spot rates:
Consolidated Entity
2024
2023
A$
A$
Cash and cash equivalents (USD)
225,722
15,473,231
Cash and cash equivalents (€EUR)
-
-
Cash and cash equivalents (£GBP)
-
-
Trade and other payables (USD)
(507,820)
(1,611,223)
Trade and other payables (€EUR)
-
-
Trade and other payables (£GBP)
(3,834)
(17,444)
Trade and other payables (JPY)
(2,992)
-
Total exposure
(288,924)
13,844,564
As shown in the table above, the Group is primarily exposed to changes in USD/AUD exchange rates. The sensitivity of profit or loss to changes in the
exchange rates arises mainly from US-dollar denominated financial instruments and there is no impact on other components of equity.
Based on the financial instruments held as of June 30, 2023, had the Australian dollar weakened/strengthened by 0.35% (2023: 3.6%),(2022: 8.19%)
against the USD with all other variables held constant, the Group’s post-tax loss for the year would have been (A$1,000) lower/higher (2021:
A$2,233,871 lower/higher).
(ii) Interest Rate Risk
The Group’s exposure to interest rate risk, which is the risk that a financial instruments value will fluctuate as a result of changes in market interest rates
and the effective weighted average interest rates on classes of financial assets and financial liabilities.
F-43
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
23. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)
(a) Market Risk (continued)
The Group’s exposure to interest rate risk has not changed since the prior year.
At June 30, 2024, the Group had the following cash accounts:
●
A$11,529,456 in an Australian dollar cash maximiser account at an interest rate of 2.7% as of June 30, 2024;
●
A$705,952 in an Australian dollar transaction account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2024;
●
A$182,048 in an Australian dollar transaction account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2024;
●
U.S.$138,388 (A$207,581) in U.S. checking accounts at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2024;
●
U.S.$12,094 (A$18,141) in U.S. Airwallex accounts at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2024
●
(A$4,293) in a Visa Credit card account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30,2024.
At June 30, 2023, the Group had the following cash accounts:
●
A$27,457 in an Australian dollar cash maximiser account at an interest rate of 1.44% as of June 30, 2023;
●
A$61,518 in an Australian dollar transaction account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2023;
●
A$18,864 in an Australian dollar transaction account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2023;
●
U.S.$10,279,099 (A$15,473,231) in U.S. checking accounts at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2023;
●
A$42,713 in a 90 days term deposit at a fixed interest rate of 3.85% which matures on August 28, 2023;
●
A$150,000 in a 90 days term deposit at a fixed interest rate of 3.85% which matures on September 2, 2023;
At June 30, 2022, the Group had the following cash accounts:
●
A$4,863,883 in an Australian dollar cash maximiser account at an interest rate of 0.29% as of June 30, 2022;
●
A$106,224 in an Australian dollar transaction account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2022;
●
A$281,415 in an Australian dollar transaction account at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2022;
●
U.S.$20,233,747 (A$29,361,393) in U.S. checking accounts at an interest rate of 0.00% as of June 30, 2022;
●
A$42,713 in a 90 days term deposit at a fixed interest rate of 0.15% which matures on September 2, 2022;
●
A$150,000 in a 90 days term deposit at a fixed interest rate of 0.15% which matures on September 7, 2022;
The weighted average interest rate is 0.05% for cash and cash equivalents and 3.85% for terms deposits for 90 days and apart from usual variances in
general rates of interest the Group is not exposed to any significant interest rate risk.
F-44
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
23. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)
(a) Market Risk (continued)
Receivables and payables are non-interest bearing.
The Group’s exposure to interest rates and the effective weighted average interest rate for classes of financial assets and liabilities is set out below:
June 30, 2024
Floating
Interest Rate
(A$)
Fixed Interest
Maturing in
(A$)
Non-Interest
bearing
(A$)
Total
(A$)
Average
Interest Rate
1 year
or less
1-5 years
Financial Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
11,529,456
(4,293)
-
1,113,722
12,638,885
2.463%
Trade and other receivables
-
-
-
4,041,675
4,041,675
Other current assets
-
30,091
-
10,577
40,668
3.515%
Total Financial Assets
11,529,456
25,798
-
5,165,974
16,721,228
Financial Liabilities
Trade and other payables
-
-
-
(4,619,947)
(4,619,947)
Lease liabilities
-
(107,131)
(51,914)
-
(159,045)
Other Current Liabilities
(100,000)
(100,000)
Total Financial Liabilities
-
(107,131)
(51,914)
(4,719,947)
(4,878,992)
June 30, 2023
Floating
Interest Rate
(A$)
Fixed Interest
Maturing in
(A$)
Non-Interest
bearing
(A$)
Total
(A$)
Average
Interest Rate
1 year
or less
1-5 years
Financial Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
27,457
192,713
-
15,553,613
15,773,783
0.050%
Trade and other receivables
-
-
-
8,665,704
8,665,704
Other current assets
-
29,150
-
-
-
4.4%
Total Financial Assets
27,457
192,713
-
24,219,317
24,439,487
Financial Liabilities
Trade and other payables
-
-
-
(3,517,708)
(3,517,708)
Lease liabilities
-
(107,177)
(103,207)
-
(210,384)
Total Financial Liabilities
-
(107,177)
(103,207)
(3,517,708)
(3,728,092)
(b) Credit Risk
Credit risk refers to the risk that a counterparty will default on its contractual obligations resulting in financial loss to the Group. The Group has no
significant concentration of credit risk and it is not the Group’s policy to hedge credit risk.
F-45
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
23. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)
(b) Credit Risk (continued)
The Group ensures that surplus cash is invested with financial institutions of appropriate credit worthiness and limits the amount of credit exposure to any
one counter party.
There has been no significant change in the Group’s exposure to credit risk since the previous year. The carrying amount of the Group’s financial assets
represents the maximum credit exposure.
(c) Liquidity Risk
Prudent liquidity risk management implies maintaining sufficient cash and the availability of funding through an adequate amount of committed credit
facilities. The Group manages liquidity risk by maintaining sufficient bank balances to fund its operations and the availability of funding through
committed credit facilities.
Management monitors rolling forecasts of the Group’s liquidity reserve on the basis of expected cash flows. See Note 1 (Going Concern Basis) of our
accompanying financial statements.
Maturities of Financial Liabilities
2024
Less than
6 months
6-12
months
Greater than
12 months
and less than
5 years
Total
contracted
cash flows
Carrying
amounts
Trade and other payables
(4,619,947)
-
-
(4,619,947)
(4,619,947)
Lease liabilities
(53,566)
(53,565)
(51,914)
(159,045)
(159,045)
Total
(4,673,513)
(53,565)
(51,914)
(4,778,992)
(4,778,992)
2023
Less than
6 months
6-12
months
Greater than
12 months
and less than
5 years
Total
contracted
cash flows
Carrying
amounts
Trade and other payables
(3,517,708)
-
-
(3,517,708)
(3,517,708)
Lease liabilities
(53,589)
(53,588)
(103,207)
(210,384)
(210,384)
Total
(3,571,297)
(53,588)
(103,207)
(3,728,092)
(3,728,092)
F-46
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
23. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)
(d) Capital Risk Management
The Group’s objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and to maintain an optimal capital
structure so as to maximize shareholder value. In order to maintain or achieve an optimal capital structure, the Group may issue new shares or reduce its
capital, subject to the provisions of the Group’s constitution. The capital structure of the Group consists of equity attributed to equity holders of the
Group, comprising contributed equity, reserves and accumulated losses disclosed in Notes 10, 11 and 12. By monitoring undiscounted cash flow forecasts
and actual cash flows provided to the Board by the Group’s Management the Board monitors the need to raise additional equity from the equity markets.
(e) Fair Value Estimation
The carrying amount of financial assets and financial liabilities recorded in the financial statements represents their respective fair values, determined in
accordance with the accounting policies disclosed in Note 1 to the financial statements.
Financial Instruments measured at Fair Value
The financial instruments recognised at fair value in the Statement of Financial Position have been analysed and classified using a fair value hierarchy
reflecting the significance of the inputs used in making the measurements. The fair value hierarchy consists of the following levels:
-
quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1);
-
inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly (as prices) or indirectly
(derived from prices) (Level 2); and
-
inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (unobservable inputs) (Level 3).
In 2023 and 2022, none of the Group’s assets and liabilities had their fair value determined using the fair value hierarchy. No transfers between the levels
of the fair value hierarchy occurred during the current or previous years.
F-47
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – in Australian dollars (unless otherwise noted)
24. PARENT ENTITY FINANCIAL INFORMATION
The individual financial statements for the parent entity show the following aggregate amounts:
June 30,
2024
2023
Statement of financial position
Current Assets
19,018,719
27,048,773
Non-current Assets
147,018
229,103
Total assets
19,165,737
27,277,876
Current liabilities
(5,101,935)
(4,993,949)
Non-current liabilities
(1,151,157)
(122,710)
Total liabilities
(6,253,092)
(5,116,659)
Shareholders’ equity
Contributed equity
223,151,570
213,971,323
Reserves
4,806,203
3,972,475
Accumulated losses
(215,045,128)
(195,782,581)
Total equity
12,912,645
22,161,217
Statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
Loss for the year
(19,355,765)
(13,967,504)
Total comprehensive loss for the year
(19,355,765)
(13,967,504)
F-48
ALTERITY THERAPEUTICS LIMITED
ADDITIONAL AUSTRALIAN FINANCIAL REPORTING REQUIREMENTS
CONSOLIDATED ENTITY DISCLOSURE STATEMENT
Name of entity
Type of entity
Trustee,
partner or
JV
% of
Share
Capital
Place of
Incorporation
Australian or
foreign resident
Foreign
jurisdiction of
foreign
residents
Alterity Therapeutics Limited
Body Corporate
-
100% Australia
Australian
n/a
Alterity Therapeutics Inc
Body Corporate
-
100%
United States of
America
United States of
America
United States of
America
Alterity Therapeutics UK Ltd
Body Corporate
-
100% United Kingdom United Kingdom United Kingdom
Basis of preparation
This consolidated entity disclosure statement (CEDS) has been prepared in accordance with the Corporations Act 2001 and includes information for each
entity that was part of the consolidated entity as at the end of the financial year in accordance with AASB 10 Consolidated Financial Statements.
Determination of tax residency
Section 295 (3A)(vi) of the Corporation Act 2001 defines tax residency as having the meaning in the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997. The
determination of tax residency involves judgement as there are different interpretations that could be adopted, and which could give rise to a different
conclusion on residency. In determining tax residency, the consolidated entity has applied the following interpretations:
●
Australian tax residency. The consolidated entity has applied current legislation and judicial precedent, including having regard to the Tax
Commissioner’s public guidance in Tax Ruling TR 2018/5
●
Foreign tax residency. Where necessary, the consolidated entity has used independent tax advisers in foreign jurisdictions to assist in its
determination of tax residency to ensure applicable foreign tax legislation has been complied with (see section 295(3A)(vii) of the Corporations
Act 2001).
79
Australian Disclosure Requirements
Directors’ Declaration
In the Directors’ opinion:
a)
the financial statements and notes set out on pages F-1 to F-48 are in accordance with the Corporations Act 2001, including:
(i)
complying with Accounting Standards, the Corporations Regulations 2001 and other mandatory professional reporting requirements, and
(ii) giving a true and fair view of the consolidated entity’s financial position as at June 30, 2024 and of its performance for the financial year
ended on that date, and
b)
there are reasonable grounds to believe that the Group will be able to pay its debts as and when they become due and payable.
c)
the consolidated entity disclosure statement on page 79 is true and correct.
Note 1 confirms that the consolidated financial statements also comply with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the
International Accounting Standards Board.
The Directors have been given the declarations by the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer required by section 295A of the
Corporations Act 2001.
This declaration is made in accordance with a resolution of Directors.
/s/ Geoffrey Kempler
Chairman
Melbourne
September 26, 2024
80
PricewaterhouseCoopers, ABN 52 780 433 757
2 Riverside Quay, SOUTHBANK VIC 3006, GPO Box 1331 MELBOURNE VIC 3001
T: +61 3 8603 1000, F: +61 3 8603 1999, www.pwc.com.au
Liability limited by a scheme approved under Professional Standards Legislation.
Independent auditor’s report
To the members of Alterity Therapeutics Limited
Report on the audit of the financial report
Our opinion
In our opinion:
The accompanying financial report of Alterity Therapeutics Limited (the Company) and its controlled
entities (together the Group) is in accordance with the Corporations Act 2001, including:
(a) giving a true and fair view of the Group's financial position as at 30 June 2024 and of its
financial performance for the year then ended
(b) complying with Australian Accounting Standards and the Corporations Regulations 2001.
What we have audited
The financial report comprises:
●
the consolidated statement of financial position as at 30 June 2024
●
the consolidated statement of changes in equity for the year then ended
●
the consolidated cash flow statement for the year then ended
●
the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive loss for the year then
ended
●
the notes to the consolidated financial statements, including material accounting policy
information and other explanatory information
●
the consolidated entity disclosure statement as at 30 June 2024
●
the directors’ declaration.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with Australian Auditing Standards. Our responsibilities under
those standards are further described in the Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial
report section of our report.
We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis
for our opinion.
Independence
We are independent of the Group in accordance with the auditor independence requirements of the
Corporations Act 2001 and the ethical requirements of the Accounting Professional & Ethical
Standards Board’s APES 110 Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants (including Independence
Standards) (the Code) that are relevant to our audit of the financial report in Australia. We have also
fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with the Code.
2
Material uncertainty related to going concern
We draw attention to Note 1 in the financial report, which indicates that the Group incurred a net loss
of $19,123,464 and a net operating cash outflow of $12,605,824 during the year ended 30 June 2024,
and that the Group will need to raise additional capital to continue the development of its planned
research and development programs. These conditions, along with other matters set forth in Note 1,
indicate that a material uncertainty exists that may cast significant doubt on the Group’s ability to
continue as a going concern. Our opinion is not modified in respect of this matter.
Our audit approach
An audit is designed to provide reasonable assurance about whether the financial report is free from
material misstatement. Misstatements may arise due to fraud or error. They are considered material if
individually or in aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of
users taken on the basis of the financial report.
We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed enough work to be able to give an
opinion on the financial report as a whole, taking into account the geographic and management
structure of the Group, its accounting processes and controls and the industry in which it operates.
Audit scope
Key audit matters
●
Our audit focused on where the Group made
subjective judgements; for example, significant
accounting estimates involving assumptions and
inherently uncertain future events.
●
Amongst other relevant topics, we communicated
the following key audit matter to the Audit and
Risk Committee:
−
Research and development tax incentive
receivable
●
This is further described in the Key audit matters
section of our report, except for the matter which
is described in the material uncertainty related to
going concern section.
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in
our audit of the financial report for the current period. The key audit matters were addressed in the
context of our audit of the financial report as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do
not provide a separate opinion on these matters. Further, any commentary on the outcomes of a
particular audit procedure is made in that context.
In addition to the matter described in the Material uncertainty related to going concern section, we
have determined the matter described below to be the key audit matter to be communicated in our
report.
3
Key audit matter
How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Research and development tax incentive
receivable
(Refer to note 5) [$4.0 million]
As described in Notes 1, 2 and 5 of the financial
report, the Group’s research and development
(“R&D”) tax incentive receivable was $4.0 million as
of 30 June 2024, which was recorded as other
income for the year ended 30 June 2024.
The Group assessed its R&D activities and related
expenditures and applied significant judgement in
determining which are eligible under the R&D tax
incentive scheme, and then recorded the expected
R&D tax incentive amount as a receivable in the
consolidated statement of financial position and as
other income in the consolidated statement of profit or
loss and other comprehensive loss.
The principal considerations for our determination that
performing procedures relating to the R&D tax
incentive receivable is a key audit matter are the
significant judgements made by the Group to
determine whether the R&D activities and related
expenditures are eligible under the R&D tax incentive
scheme. This in turn led to a high degree of auditor
subjectivity, judgement and effort in performing
procedures to evaluate the audit evidence related to
the valuation of the R&D tax incentive receivable.
Our audit procedures included, among others, testing
the Group’s process for determining the R&D tax
incentive receivable, which included:
●
evaluating the appropriateness of the
valuation methodology used to estimate the
amount of the R&D tax incentive receivable;
●
testing the completeness and accuracy of
the underlying expense data used to
determine the R&D tax incentive receivable;
and
●
evaluating, for a selection of eligible
expenditures, the appropriateness of the
Group’s assessment of eligibility.
The work of the Group’s expert was used in
performing the procedures to evaluate the
appropriateness of the R&D tax incentive receivable.
As a basis for using this work, the expert’s
qualifications were understood and the Group’s
relationship with the expert was assessed. The
procedures performed also included an evaluation of
the methods and significant assumptions used by the
expert and an evaluation of the expert’s findings.
Other information
The directors are responsible for the other information. The other information comprises the
information included in the annual report for the year ended 30 June 2024, but does not include the
financial report and our auditor’s report thereon.
Our opinion on the financial report does not cover the other information and accordingly we do not
express any form of assurance conclusion thereon through our opinion on the financial report. We
have issued a separate opinion on the remuneration report.
In connection with our audit of the financial report, our responsibility is to read the other information
and, in doing so, consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent with the financial
report or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to be materially misstated.
4
If, based on the work we have performed on the other information that we obtained prior to the date of
this auditor’s report, we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other information, we are
required to report that fact. We have nothing to report in this regard.
Responsibilities of the directors for the financial report
The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation of the financial report in accordance
with Australian Accounting Standards and the Corporations Act 2001, including giving a true and fair
view, and for such internal control as the directors determine is necessary to enable the preparation of
the financial report that is free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial report, the directors are responsible for assessing the ability of the Group to
continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the
going concern basis of accounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the Group or to cease
operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial report
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial report as a whole is
free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an auditor’s report that
includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that
an audit conducted in accordance with the Australian Auditing Standards will always detect a material
misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material
if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic
decisions of users taken on the basis of the financial report.
A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial report is located at the Auditing
and Assurance Standards Board website at:
https://www.auasb.gov.au/admin/file/content102/c3/ar1_2020.pdf. This description forms part of our
auditor's report.
Report on the remuneration report
Our opinion on the remuneration report
We have audited the remuneration report included in Item 6 (Directors, Senior Management and
Employees) of the Form 20-F for the year ended 30 June 2024 identified by the title ‘Start of the
Remuneration Report for Australian Disclosure Requirements’ to ‘End of Remuneration Report’.
In our opinion, the remuneration report of Alterity Therapeutics Limited for the year ended 30 June
2024 complies with section 300A of the Corporations Act 2001.
5
Responsibilities
The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation and presentation of the
remuneration report in accordance with section 300A of the Corporations Act 2001. Our responsibility
is to express an opinion on the remuneration report, based on our audit conducted in accordance with
Australian Auditing Standards.
PricewaterhouseCoopers
Ben Gargett
Melbourne
Partner
26 September 2024
PricewaterhouseCoopers, ABN 52 780 433 757
2 Riverside Quay, SOUTHBANK VIC 3006, GPO Box 1331, MELBOURNE VIC 3001
T: 61 3 8603 1000, F: 61 3 8603 1999, www.pwc.com.au
Liability limited by a scheme approved under Professional Standards Legislation.
Auditor’s Independence Declaration
As lead auditor for the audit of Alterity Therapeutics Limited for the year ended 30 June 2024, I
declare that to the best of my knowledge and belief, there have been:
(a) no contraventions of the auditor independence requirements of the Corporations Act 2001 in
relation to the audit; and
(b) no contraventions of any applicable code of professional conduct in relation to the audit.
This declaration is in respect of Alterity Therapeutics Limited and the entities it controlled during the
period.
Ben Gargett
Melbourne
Partner
PricewaterhouseCoopers
26 September 2024
ITEM 19. EXHIBITS
Index to Exhibits.
Incorporated by
Reference
Exhibit
Number
Exhibit Description
Form
Exhibit
Filing Date/
Period End
Date
1
Constitution of Registrant.
20-F
1.1
6/30/09
2.1
Deposit Agreement dated March 23, 2001, as amended and restated as of December 21,
2007, among the Registrant, the Bank of New York, as Depositary, and owners and holders
from time to time of ADRs issued thereunder, including the Form of American Depositary
Receipts.
F-6 POS
1
12/21/07
2.2
Certificate of Registration on Change of Name.
F-3
4.2
5/13/19
2.3
Rights Attached to Ordinary Shares.
4.1
2018 American Depository Share (ADS) Option Plan.
6-K
Annexure A
to Item 1
11/3/04
4.2
2004 Employees’, Directors’ and Consultants’ Share and Option Plan.
6-K
Annexure B
to Item 1
11/3/04
4.3
Sales Agreement dated February 15, 2024 between Alterity Therapeutics Limited and
JonesTrading Institutional Services LLC
6-K
1.1
02/15/2024
8.1*
List of Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
11.1*
Securities Trading Policy
12.1*
Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
12.2*
Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) under the Securities
Exchange Act, as amended.
13.1*
Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted
pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
13.2*
Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted
pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
15.1*
Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers.
15.2*
Auditor’s independence declaration.
97.1*
Incentive-Based Compensation Recovery Policy Effective November 1, 2023
101.INS
Inline XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document.
101.CAL
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.
101.DEF
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document.
101.LAB
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document.
101.PRE
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document.
104
Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101).
*
Filed herewith.
81
SIGNATURES
The Registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the
undersigned to sign this report on its behalf.
Alterity Therapeutics Limited
By:
/s/ David A. Stamler
David A. Stamler
Chief Executive Officer
Dated September 26, 2024
82
Shareholder information
June 30, 2024
A lterity Therapeutics Limited
83
The shareholder information set out below was applicable as at September 24, 2024.
A.
Distribution of equity securities
Ordinary shares
5,320,336,118 fully paid ordinary shares are held by 5,552 individual shareholders. All ordinary shares carry one
vote per share.
Analysis of numbers of equity security holders by size of holding:
No. of
Holding
holders
1 - 1000
497
1,001 - 5,000
1,043
5,001 - 10,000
470
10,001 - 100,000
1,942
100,001 and over
1,600
5,552
including:
Unmarketable parcels
4,222
Options
• 35,000,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.09 on or before 17 September 2025, are held by 4 individual shareholders
• 91,392,720 unlisted options exercisable at $0.03 on or before 6 January 2026, are held by 1 individual shareholder
• 12,000,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.07 on or before 31 July 2024, are held by 1 individual shareholder
• 14,250,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.04 on or before 29 November 2026, are held by 7 individual shareholders
• 11,900,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.02 on or before 29 November 2026, are held by 3 individual shareholders
• 8,000,000 unlisted options exercisable at 0.0105 on or before 19 December 2026, are held by 1 individual shareholder
• 120,000,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.003 on or before 21 March 2029, are held by 1 individual shareholder
• 26,500,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.004 on or before 13 March 2029, are held by 5 individual shareholders
• 62,500,000 unlisted options exercisable at $0.0047 on or before 13 March 2029, are held by 5 individual shareholders
• 932,706,668 free-attaching options exercisable at $0.01 on or before 31 August 2026, are held by 341 individual shareholders
All options do not carry a right to vote. Voting rights will be attached to the unissued shares when the options
have been exercised.
Alterity Therapeutics Limited
Shareholder information
June 30, 2024 (continued)
84
B.
Equity security holders
Twenty largest quoted equity security holders
The names of the twenty largest holders of quoted equity securities are listed below:
Name
Ordinary Shares
Number Held
Percentage
of issued
shares
HSBC CUSTODY NOMINEES (AUSTRALIA) LIMITED
2,181,650,785
41.01
CITICORP NOMINEES PTY LIMITED
166,549,148
3.13
BUTTONWOOD NOMINEES PTY LTD
103,382,234
1.94
KYRIACO BARBER PTY LTD
65,000,000
1.22
MST FINANCIAL SERVICES PTY LTD
52,517,122
0.99
ANDREW MARK WILMOT SETON
44,203,475
0.83
ONE MANAGED INVESTMENT FUNDS LIMITED
Continue reading text version or see original annual report in PDF format above